blob: c50700f12495bdddd54c5bcc2f2aeb771aca19be [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau86512dd2021-04-09 17:10:39 +02007 2021/04/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200923 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100924 - presetenv
925 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926 - uid
927 - ulimit-n
928 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200929 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100930 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100931 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200933 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-options
937 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200938 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-options
940 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200942 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100943 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100945 - 51degrees-data-file
946 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200947 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200948 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200949 - wurfl-data-file
950 - wurfl-information-list
951 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200952 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100953 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100956 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200957 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200959 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100960 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100961 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200963 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200964 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200965 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200966 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200967 - noepoll
968 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000969 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100971 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300972 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000973 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100974 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200975 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200976 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200977 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000978 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000979 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200980 - tune.buffers.limit
981 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200982 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200983 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100984 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200985 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200986 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200987 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200988 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100989 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200990 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200991 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200992 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100993 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100995 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100996 - tune.lua.session-timeout
997 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200998 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100999 - tune.maxaccept
1000 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001001 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001002 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001003 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001004 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1005 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1007 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001008 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001009 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001010 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001011 - tune.sndbuf.client
1012 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001013 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001014 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001015 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001016 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001018 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001019 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001020 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001021 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001022 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001023 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1024 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001026 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1027 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001031 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035------------------------------------
1036
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037ca-base <dir>
1038 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001039 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1040 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1041 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043chroot <jail dir>
1044 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1045 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1046 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1047 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1048 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001049 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001050
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001051cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1052 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1053 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1054 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1055 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1056 set. These sets have the format
1057
1058 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1059
1060 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001062 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1063 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001064 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1065 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001066 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1067 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1068 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1069 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1070 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1071 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1072 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1073 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1074 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1075 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001076
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001077 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1078 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1079 on the machine's word size.
1080
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001081 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001082 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1083 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1084 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1085 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1086 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1087 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001088
1089 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001090 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1091
1092 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1093 # first 4 CPUs
1094
1095 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1096 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1097 # word size.
1098
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001099 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001100 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001101 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1102 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1103 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1104
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001105 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1106 # and so on.
1107 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1108 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1109 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001111 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001112 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1113 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1114 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1115
1116 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1117 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1118 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1119
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001120 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1121 # and a thread range.
1122 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1123 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1124 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1125
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001126crt-base <dir>
1127 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001128 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1129 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131daemon
1132 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1133 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001134 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1135 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001137deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1138 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001139 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001140
1141deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001143 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1144
1145deviceatlas-separator <char>
1146 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1147 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1148
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001149deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001150 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1151 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1152 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001153
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001154external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001155 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1156 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001157 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1158 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1159 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1160 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1161 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001164 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001165 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1166 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001167 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1168 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001170
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001171group <group name>
1172 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1173 See also "gid" and "user".
1174
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001175hard-stop-after <time>
1176 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1177
1178 Arguments :
1179 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1180 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1181 SIGUSR1 signal.
1182
1183 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1184 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1185 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1186
1187 Example:
1188 global
1189 hard-stop-after 30s
1190
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001191h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1192 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1193 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1194 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1195 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001196 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001197 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1198 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1199 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1200 specified in a proxy.
1201
1202 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1203 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1204 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1205 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1206 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1207 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1208 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1209
1210 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1211 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1212 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1213 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1214 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1215
1216 Example:
1217 global
1218 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1219
1220 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1221 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1222
1223h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1224 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1225 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1226 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1227 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1228 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1229 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1230 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1231 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1232
1233 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1234 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1235 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1236
1237 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1238 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1239
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001240insecure-fork-wanted
1241 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1242 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1243 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1244 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1245 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1246 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1247 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1248 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1249 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1250 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1251 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1252 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1253 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1254 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1255 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1256 disable it.
1257
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001258insecure-setuid-wanted
1259 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1260 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1261 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1262 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1263 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1264 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1265 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1266 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1267 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1268 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1269 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1270 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1271 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1272 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1273
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001274issuers-chain-path <dir>
1275 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1276 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1277 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1278 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1279 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1280 "issuers-chain-path".
1281 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1282 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1283 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1284 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1285 will share the chain in memory.
1286
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001287localpeer <name>
1288 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1289 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1290 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1291 the configuration parsing.
1292
1293 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1294 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1295
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001296log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001297 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001298 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001300 configured with "log global".
1301
1302 <address> can be one of:
1303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001304 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001305 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1306 port).
1307
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001308 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1309 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1310 port).
1311
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001312 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001313 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1314 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001315 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001316
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001317 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1318 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1319 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1320 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1321 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1322 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1323 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1324 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1325 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1326 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1327 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1328 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1329 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1330 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001331 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1332 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001333
1334 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1335 "fd@2", see above.
1336
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001337 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1338 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1339 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1340 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1341 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1342
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001343 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1344 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001345
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001346 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1347 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1348 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1349 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1350 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1351 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1352 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1353 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1354 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1355 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001356 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1357 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001358
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001359 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1360 one of the following :
1361
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001362 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1363 field is stripped. This is the default.
1364 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1365 rfc3164.
1366
1367 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001368 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1369
1370 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1371 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1372
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001373 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1374 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1375 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1376 designed to be used with a local log server.
1377
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001378 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1379 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1380 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1381 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1382 logger consumes.
1383
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001384 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1385 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1386 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1387 used with a local log server.
1388
1389 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1390 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1391 designed to be used with a local log server.
1392
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001393 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1394 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1395 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1396 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1397
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001398 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1399 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1400 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1401 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1402 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1403
1404 <sample_size>
1405 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1406 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1407 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1408 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1409 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1410
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001411 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001413 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1414 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1415 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1416
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001417 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1418 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1419 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1420 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001421
1422 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001423 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1424 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1425 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1426 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1427 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1428 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001430 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001431
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001432log-send-hostname [<string>]
1433 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1434 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1435 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1436 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1437 the logs.
1438
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001439log-tag <string>
1440 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1441 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1442 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001443 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001444
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001445lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001446 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1447 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1448 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1449 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1450 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1451 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001452 used multiple times.
1453
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001454lua-load-per-thread <file>
1455 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1456 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1457 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1458 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1459 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1460 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1461 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1462 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1463 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1464 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1465 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1466 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1467 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1468 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1469 times.
1470
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001471lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1472 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1473 variable.
1474 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1475 to "path".
1476
1477 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1478 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1479 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1480 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1481 will be checked earlier.
1482
1483 As an example by specifying the following path:
1484
1485 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1486 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1487
1488 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1489 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1490 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1491 paths if that does not exist either.
1492
1493 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1494 documentation.
1495
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001496master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001497 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1498 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1499 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001501 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1502 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001503 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1504 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1505 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1506 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1507 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001508
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001509 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001510
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001511mworker-max-reloads <number>
1512 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001513 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001514 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1515 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1516 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1517
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001518nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001519 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1520 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1521 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001522 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1523 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001524 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1525 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1526 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001527
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001528nbthread <number>
1529 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001530 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1531 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1532 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1533 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1534 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001535 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1536 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1537 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1538 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1539 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1540 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1541 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001543pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001544 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1545 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1546 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1547 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001549pp2-never-send-local
1550 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1551 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1552 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1553 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1554 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1555 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1556 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1557 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1558 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1559 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1560 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1561
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001562presetenv <name> <value>
1563 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1564 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1565 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1566 and "unsetenv".
1567
1568resetenv [<name> ...]
1569 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1570 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1571 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1572 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1573 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1574 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1575 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1576 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1577
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001578stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001579 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1580 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1581 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1582 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1583 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1584 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001585 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001586 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1587 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1588 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1589 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001590
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001591server-state-base <directory>
1592 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001593 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1594 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001595
1596server-state-file <file>
1597 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1598 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1599 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1600 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1601 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1602 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1603 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1604 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001605 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1606 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001607
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001608set-var <var-name> <expr>
1609 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1610 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1611 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1612 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1613 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1614 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1615 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1616 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1617 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1618
1619 Example:
1620 global
1621 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1622 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1623 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1624
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001625setenv <name> <value>
1626 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1627 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1628 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1629 and "unsetenv".
1630
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001631set-dumpable
1632 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001633 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1634 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1635 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1636 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1637 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1638 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1639 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1640 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1641 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1642 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1643 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1644 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1645 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1646 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1647 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1648 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1649 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001655 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001656 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1657 information and recommendations see e.g.
1658 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1659 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1660 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1661 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001662
1663ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1665 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1666 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1667 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1668 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001669 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1670 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1671 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001672 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001673
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001674ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1676 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1677 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1678 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1679 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1680
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001681ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1683 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1684 keyword to see available options.
1685
1686 Example:
1687 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001688 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001689
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001690ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1692 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001693 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001694 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001695 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1696 information and recommendations see e.g.
1697 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1698 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1699 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1700 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1701 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001702
1703ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1705 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1706 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1707 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1708 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001709 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1710 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1711 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1712 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001713
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001714ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1716 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1717 keyword to see available options.
1718
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001719ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1721 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1722 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001724 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001725 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1726 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1727 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1728 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001729 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1730 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1731 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1732
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001733ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1734 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1735 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001736 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001737 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001738 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1739
1740 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001741
1742 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1743 and won't try to remove them.
1744
1745 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1746
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001747ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001748 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001749 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1750 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001751
1752 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1753 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1754 optimize the startup time.
1755
1756 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1757 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1758 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1759
1760 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001761 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001762
1763 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001764 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1765
1766 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1767 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1768 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1769 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1770 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1771 bind configuration..
1772
1773 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1774 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1775 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1776 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1777 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1778 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1779 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1780 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1781
1782 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1783
1784 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1785 a cert bundle.
1786
1787 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1788 separately in several "crt".
1789
1790 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1791 since files are loading separately.
1792
1793 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1794 required to commit them.
1795
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001796 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001797 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001798
1799 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1800
1801 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1802
1803 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1804 not provided in the PEM file.
1805
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001806 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1807 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1808
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001809 The default behavior is "all".
1810
1811 Example:
1812 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1813 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1814 ssl-load-extra-files none
1815
1816 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1817
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001818ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1819 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1820 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1821 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1822
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001823ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001824 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001825 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1826 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1827 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1828 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1829 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1830 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001831 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001832
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001833stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1834 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1835 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1836 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001837 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001838 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001839
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001840 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1841 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1842 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001843
1844stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1845 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1846 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001847 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001848
1849stats maxconn <connections>
1850 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1851 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1852
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001853uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001854 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001855 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1856 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1857 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1858
1859ulimit-n <number>
1860 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1861 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1862 option.
1863
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001864unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1865 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1866
1867 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1868 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1869 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1870 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1871 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1872 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1873 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1874 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1875 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1876 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1877
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001878unsetenv [<name> ...]
1879 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1880 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1881 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1882 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1883 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1884 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1885 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001887user <user name>
1888 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1889 See also "uid" and "group".
1890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001891node <name>
1892 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1893
1894 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1895 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1896 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1897 traffic.
1898
1899description <text>
1900 Add a text that describes the instance.
1901
1902 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1903 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1904 "<" and ">" characters.
1905
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100190651degrees-data-file <file path>
1907 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001909
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001910 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001911 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1912
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000191351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001914 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1915 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1916 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1917
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001918 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001919 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1920
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200192151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001922 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1923 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1924
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001925 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1926 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1927
192851degrees-cache-size <number>
1929 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1930 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1931 By default, this cache is disabled.
1932
1933 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001934 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1935
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001936wurfl-data-file <file path>
1937 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1938 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1939
1940 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1941 with USE_WURFL=1.
1942
1943wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1944 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1945 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1946 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1947
1948 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1949
1950 Valid WURFL properties are:
1951 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1952
1953 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1954 device.
1955
1956 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1957 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1958
1959 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1960 particular web request.
1961
1962 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1963 used Libwurfl API version.
1964
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001965 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1966 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1967
1968 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1969 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1970
1971 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1972
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001973 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1974 with USE_WURFL=1.
1975
1976wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1977 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1978 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1979
1980 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1981 with USE_WURFL=1.
1982
1983wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1984 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1985 thus before the chroot.
1986
1987 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1988 with USE_WURFL=1.
1989
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001990wurfl-cache-size <size>
1991 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1992 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001993 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001994 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001995
1996 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1997 with USE_WURFL=1.
1998
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001999strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002000 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2001 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2002 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2003 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2004 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007-----------------------
2008
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002009busy-polling
2010 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2011 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2012 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2013 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2014 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2015 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2016 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2017 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2018 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2019 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2020 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2021 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2022 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2023 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2024 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2025 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2026 "poll" pollers.
2027
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002028 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2029 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2030 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2031
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002032max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2033 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2034 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2035 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2036 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2037 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2038 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2039 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2040 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2041
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002042maxconn <number>
2043 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2044 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2045 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002046 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2047 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2048 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2049 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002050 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2051 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2052 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2053 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2054 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2055 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002056
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002057maxconnrate <number>
2058 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2065 fairness.
2066
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002067maxcomprate <number>
2068 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002069 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002070 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2071 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2072 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002074 default value.
2075
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002076maxcompcpuusage <number>
2077 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2078 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2079 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2080 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2081 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2082 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2083 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2084 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2085
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002086maxpipes <number>
2087 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2088 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2089 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2090 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2091 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2092 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2093
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002094maxsessrate <number>
2095 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2096 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2097 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2098 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2099 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2100 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2101 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2102 fairness.
2103
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002104maxsslconn <number>
2105 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2106 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2107 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2108 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2109 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2110 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2111 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002112 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2113 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2114 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2115 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2116 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2117 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2118 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002119
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002120maxsslrate <number>
2121 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2122 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2123 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2124 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2125 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2126 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2127 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2128 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2129 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2130 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2131
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002132maxzlibmem <number>
2133 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2134 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2135 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002136 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2137 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2138 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002140noepoll
2141 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2142 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002143 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
2145nokqueue
2146 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2147 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2148 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2149
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002150noevports
2151 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2152 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2153 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2154 also "nopoll".
2155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002156nopoll
2157 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2158 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002160 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2161 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002162
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002163nosplice
2164 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002165 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002166 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002167 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002168 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2169 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2170 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2171 "option splice-response".
2172
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002173nogetaddrinfo
2174 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2175 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2176
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002177noreuseport
2178 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2179 command line argument "-dR".
2180
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002181profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2182 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2183 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2184 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2185 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002186 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002187 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2188 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2189 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2190 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2191
2192 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2193 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2194 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2195 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2196 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002197 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2198 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2199 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2200 CLI.
2201
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002202spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002203 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2204 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2205 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2206 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2207 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2208 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002209
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002211 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002212 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002213 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2214 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2215 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2216 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2217 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002218 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2219 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002220 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2221 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2222 openssl configuration file uses:
2223 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2224
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002225ssl-mode-async
2226 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002227 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002228 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2229 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2230 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002231 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002232 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002233
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002234tune.buffers.limit <number>
2235 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2236 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2237 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2238 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2239 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002240 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002241 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2242 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2243 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2244 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2245 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2246 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2247 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2248 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2249 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2250
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002251tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2252 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2253 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2254 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2255 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2256
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002257tune.bufsize <number>
2258 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2259 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2260 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2261 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2262 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2263 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2264 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002265 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2266 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2267 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002268 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002269 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2270 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2271 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002272
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002273tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2274 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002275
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002276tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2277 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2278 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2279 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2280 this value. The default value is 1.
2281
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002282tune.fail-alloc
2283 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2284 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2285 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2286 gracefully.
2287
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002288tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2289 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2290 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2291 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2292 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2293 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2294
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002295tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2296 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2297 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2298 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2299 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2300 change it.
2301
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002302tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2303 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002304 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2305 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002306 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2307 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2308 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2309 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2310 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2311
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002312tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2313 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2314 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2315 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2316 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2317 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2318 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2319 recommended not to change this value.
2320
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002321tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2322 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2323 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2324 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2325 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2326 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2327 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2328 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2329
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002330tune.http.cookielen <number>
2331 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2332 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2333 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2334 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2335 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2336 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2337 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2338 to change this value.
2339
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002340tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002341 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2342 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002343 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002344 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002345 configuration directives too.
2346 The default value is 1024.
2347
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002348tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2349 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2350 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2351 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2352 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2353 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2354 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002355 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2356 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2357 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002358
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002359tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2360 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2361 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2362 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2363 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2364 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2365 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002366 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2367 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2368 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2369 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2370 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002371
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002372tune.idletimer <timeout>
2373 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2374 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2375 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2376 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2377 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2378 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002379 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002380 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002381 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2382
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002383tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2384 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2385 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2386 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2387 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2388 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2389 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2390 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2391 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2392 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2393
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002394tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2395 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002396 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002397 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2398 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002399 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002400 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2401 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2402
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002403tune.lua.maxmem
2404 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2405 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2406 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2407 memory.
2408
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002409tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2410 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002411 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2412 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002413 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002414
2415tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2416 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2417 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2418 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2419 check servers.
2420
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002421tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2422 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2423 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2424 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002425 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002426
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002427tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002428 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2429 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002430 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2431 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2432 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2433 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2434 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2435 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2436 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2437 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2438 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002439
2440tune.maxpollevents <number>
2441 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2442 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2443 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2444 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2445 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2446
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002447tune.maxrewrite <number>
2448 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2449 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2450 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2451 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2452 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2453 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2454 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2455 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2456 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2457 bufsize.
2458
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002459tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2460 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2461 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2462 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2463 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2464 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2465 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2466 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2467 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2468 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002469 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2470 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002471 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2472 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2473 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2474 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2475 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2476 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2477 setting this parameter to 0.
2478
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002479tune.pipesize <number>
2480 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2481 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2482 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2483 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2484 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2485 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2486
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002487tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2488 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2489 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2490 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2491 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2492 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2493 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002494 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002495
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002496tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2497 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2498 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2499 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2500 default is 20.
2501
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002502tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2503tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2504 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2505 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2506 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002507 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002508 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002509 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2510 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2511
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002512tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002513 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002514 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2515 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2516 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2517 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2518
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002519tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002520 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002521 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2522 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2523 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2524 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2525 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2526 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2527 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002528
2529tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2530 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2531 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2532 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2533 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2534 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2535 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2536 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2537 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2538 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002539
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002540tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2541tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2542 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2543 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2544 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002545 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002546 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002547 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2548 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2549 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2550 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2551 notifying haproxy again.
2552
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002553tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002554 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002555 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2556 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2557 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2558 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2559 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2560 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2561 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2562 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2563 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2564 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2565 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002566
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002567tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002568 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002569 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2570 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2571 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2572 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2573 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2574
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002575tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2576 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2577 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2578 performances. This is disabled by default.
2579
2580 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2581 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2582
2583 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2584
2585 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2586
2587 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2588
2589 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2590 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2591 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2592
2593 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2594 converted.
2595
2596 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2597 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2598 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2599 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2600 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2601 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2602 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002603 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2604 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002605
2606 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2607
2608 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2609 only need this line:
2610
2611 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2612
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002613tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2614 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002615 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002616 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2617 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2618 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2619 being used for too long.
2620
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002621tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2622 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2623 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2624 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2625 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2626 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2627 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2628 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2629 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2630 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2631 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002632 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002633 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002634
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002635tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2636 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2637 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2638 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2639 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002640 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002641 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2642 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002643 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2644 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002645
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002646tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2647 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2648 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2649 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2650 1000 entries.
2651
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002652tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2653 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2654 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2655 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2656
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002657tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002658tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002659tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2660tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2661tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002662 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2663 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2664 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2665 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2666 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2667 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2668 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2669 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002670
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002671 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2672 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2673 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2674 all available space is consumed.
2675 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2676 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2677 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002678
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002679tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2680 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002681 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002682 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002683 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002684 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2685
2686tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2687 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2688 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002689 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2690 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026923.3. Debugging
2693--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002695quiet
2696 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2697 line argument "-q".
2698
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002699zero-warning
2700 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2701 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2702 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2703 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2704 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2705 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2706
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027083.4. Userlists
2709--------------
2710It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2711http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2712it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2713
2714userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002715 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002716 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2717
2718group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002719 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002720 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2721 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2722
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002723user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2724 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002725 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2726 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002727 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2728 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2729 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2730 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002731
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002732 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2733 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2734 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2735 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2736 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2737 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2738 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2739 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2740 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002741
2742 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002743 userlist L1
2744 group G1 users tiger,scott
2745 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002746
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002747 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2748 user scott insecure-password elgato
2749 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002750
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002751 userlist L2
2752 group G1
2753 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002754
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002755 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2756 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2757 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002758
2759 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002760
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002761
27623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002764It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2765several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2766instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2767values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2768automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2769In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2770using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2771tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2772reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2773Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2774that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2775each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002776
2777peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002778 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002779 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2780
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002781bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2782 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2783 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2784
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002785disabled
2786 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2787 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2788 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2789
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002790default-bind [param*]
2791 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2792
2793default-server [param*]
2794 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2795
2796 Arguments:
2797 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2798 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2799 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2800 details.
2801
2802
2803 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2804
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002805enable
2806 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2807
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002808log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002809 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2810 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2811 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2812 more details.
2813
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002814peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002815 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2816 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002817 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2818 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2819 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2820 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2821 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002822
2823 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2824 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2825
2826 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002827 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2828 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2829 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002830
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002831 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2832 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002833
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002834 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2835 "server" keyword explanation below).
2836
2837server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002838 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002839 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2840 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2841 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2842 of this "peers" section).
2843 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2844
2845
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002846 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002847 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002848 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002849 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2850 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2851 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002852
2853 backend mybackend
2854 mode tcp
2855 balance roundrobin
2856 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2857 stick on src
2858
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002859 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2860 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002861
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002862 Example:
2863 peers mypeers
2864 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2865 default-server ssl verify none
2866 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2867 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002868
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002869
2870table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2871 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2872
2873 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2874 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002875 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002876 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2877 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2878 "stick-table" keyword).
2879
2880 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2881 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2882 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2883 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2884 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2885 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2886 of the stick-table name as follows:
2887
2888 peers mypeers
2889 peer A ...
2890 peer B ...
2891 table t1 ...
2892
2893 frontend fe1
2894 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2895
2896 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2897 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2898
2899 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2900 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2901 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2902 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2903 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2904 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2905 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2906
2907 peers mypeers
2908 peer A ...
2909 peer B ...
2910 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2911
2912 backend t1
2913 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2914
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002915 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002916 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2917 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2918
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029193.6. Mailers
2920------------
2921It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2922If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2923in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2924
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002925mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002926 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2927 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2928
2929mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2930 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2931
2932 Example:
2933 mailers mymailers
2934 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2935 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2936
2937 backend mybackend
2938 mode tcp
2939 balance roundrobin
2940
2941 email-alert mailers mymailers
2942 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2943 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2944
2945 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2946 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2947
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002948timeout mail <time>
2949 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2950 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2951 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2952 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2953
2954 Example:
2955 mailers mymailers
2956 timeout mail 20s
2957 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002958
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029593.7. Programs
2960-------------
2961In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2962master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2963managed the same way as the workers.
2964
2965During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2966sequence as a worker:
2967
2968 - the master is re-executed
2969 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2970 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2971 instance of the program
2972
2973During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2974
2975program <name>
2976 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2977 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2978 the management guide).
2979
2980command <command> [arguments*]
2981 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2982 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2983 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2984 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2985
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002986user <user name>
2987 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2988 See also "group".
2989
2990group <group name>
2991 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2992 See also "user".
2993
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002994option start-on-reload
2995no option start-on-reload
2996 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2997 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2998 program section.
2999
3000
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010030013.8. HTTP-errors
3002----------------
3003
3004It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3005imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3006several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3007
3008http-errors <name>
3009 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3010 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3011
3012errorfile <code> <file>
3013 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3014
3015 Arguments :
3016 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003017 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003018 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003019
3020 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3021 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3022 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3023 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3024 before any chroot is performed.
3025
3026 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3027
3028 Example:
3029 http-errors website-1
3030 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3031 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3032 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3033
3034 http-errors website-2
3035 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3036 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3037 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3038
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030393.9. Rings
3040----------
3041
3042It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3043servers or traces.
3044
3045ring <ringname>
3046 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3047
3048description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003049 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003050 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3051
3052format <format>
3053 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3054
3055 Arguments:
3056 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3057 one of the following :
3058
3059 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3060 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3061 designed to be used with a local log server.
3062
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003063 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3064 field is stripped. This is the default.
3065 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3066 rfc3164.
3067
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003068 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3069 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3070 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3071 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3072 is the default.
3073
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003074 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003075 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3076
3077 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3078 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3079
3080 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3081 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3082 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3083 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3084 logger consumes.
3085
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003086 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3087 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3088 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3089 with a local log server.
3090
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003091 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3092 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3093 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3094 used with a local log server.
3095
3096maxlen <length>
3097 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3098 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3099 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3100
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003101server <name> <address> [param*]
3102 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3103 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3104 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3105 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3106 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3107 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3108 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3109 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3110 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003111 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3112 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003113
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003114size <size>
3115 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3116 set to BUFSIZE.
3117
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003118timeout connect <timeout>
3119 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3120
3121 Arguments :
3122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3124 as explained at the top of this document.
3125
3126timeout server <timeout>
3127 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3128
3129 Arguments :
3130 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3131 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3132 as explained at the top of this document.
3133
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003134 Example:
3135 global
3136 log ring@myring local7
3137
3138 ring myring
3139 description "My local buffer"
3140 format rfc3164
3141 maxlen 1200
3142 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003143 timeout connect 5s
3144 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003145 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003146
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031473.10. Log forwarding
3148-------------------
3149
3150It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3151haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3152
3153log-forward <name>
3154 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3155
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003156backlog <conns>
3157 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3158 on connections accept.
3159
3160bind <addr> [param*]
3161 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003162 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3163 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3164 syslog protocol over TCP.
3165 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003166 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3167
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003168dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003169 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3170 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3171 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3172 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003173 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003174
3175log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003176log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003177 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3178 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3179 documentation.
3180 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3181 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3182 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3183 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3184 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3185
3186 Example:
3187 global
3188 log stderr format iso local7
3189
3190 ring myring
3191 description "My local buffer"
3192 format rfc5424
3193 maxlen 1200
3194 size 32764
3195 timeout connect 5s
3196 timeout server 10s
3197 # syslog tcp server
3198 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3199
3200 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003201 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3202 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003203 # all messages on stderr
3204 log global
3205 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3206 log ring@myring local0
3207 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3208 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3209 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3210 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3211 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003212
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003213maxconn <conns>
3214 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3215 10 is the default.
3216
3217timeout client <timeout>
3218 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032204. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003221----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003223Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003224 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3225 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3226 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3227 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003228
3229A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3230connections.
3231
3232A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3233to forward incoming connections.
3234
3235A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3236parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3237
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003238A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3239ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3240sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3241the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3242explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3243from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3244"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3245for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3246to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3247optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3248are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3249any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3250names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3251that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3252duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3253names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3254
3255Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3256settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3257of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3258profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3259timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3262'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3263case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3264
3265Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3266logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3267proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3268However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3269name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3270
3271Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3272and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003273bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3275modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3276arbitrary criteria.
3277
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003278In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3279a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003280the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003281
3282 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3283 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3284 between responses and new requests.
3285
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003286 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3287 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3288 client-facing connection remains open.
3289
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003290 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3291 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003292
3293The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3294frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3295following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003296weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003298 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003299
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003300 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3301 ----+-----+-----+----
3302 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3303 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003304 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3305 ----+-----+-----+----
3306 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003307
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003308It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3309only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3310into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3311as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3312content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3313and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3314possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003315
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003316There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3317first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3318processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3319second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3320protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3321is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3322new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3323to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3324process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3325already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3326HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3327evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3328one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3329
3330There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3331performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3332tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3333preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3334analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3335HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3336header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3337mitigate this drawback.
3338
3339It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3340method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3341set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3342in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3343is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3344to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3345above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3346to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3347"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3348frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3349frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3350as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3351upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3352on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3353the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3354upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3355frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3356remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3359--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003361The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3362limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3363they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3364limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003366option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003367and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3368with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3369specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003371
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003372 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3373------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3374acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003375backlog X X X -
3376balance X - X X
3377bind - X X -
3378bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003379capture cookie - X X -
3380capture request header - X X -
3381capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003382clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3383clitcpka-idle X X X -
3384clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003385compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003386cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003387declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003388default-server X - X X
3389default_backend X X X -
3390description - X X X
3391disabled X X X X
3392dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003393email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003394email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003395email-alert mailers X X X X
3396email-alert myhostname X X X X
3397email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003398enabled X X X X
3399errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003400errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003401errorloc X X X X
3402errorloc302 X X X X
3403-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3404errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003405force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003406filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003407fullconn X - X X
3408grace X X X X
3409hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003410http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003411http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003412http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003413http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003414http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003415http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003416http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003417http-check set-var X - X X
3418http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003419http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003420http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003421http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003422http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003423http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003424id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003425ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003426load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003427log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003428log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003429log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003430log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003431max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003432maxconn X X X -
3433mode X X X X
3434monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003435monitor-uri X X X -
3436option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3437option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3438option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3439option allbackups (*) X - X X
3440option checkcache (*) X - X X
3441option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3442option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003443option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3445option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003446-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3447option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003448option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3449option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003450option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003451option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003452option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003453option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003454option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003455option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3456option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3457option httpchk X - X X
3458option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003459option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003460option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003461option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003462option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003463option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003464option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3465option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3466option logasap (*) X X X -
3467option mysql-check X - X X
3468option nolinger (*) X X X X
3469option originalto X X X X
3470option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003471option pgsql-check X - X X
3472option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003473option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003474option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003475option smtpchk X - X X
3476option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3477option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3478option splice-request (*) X X X X
3479option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003480option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003481option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3482option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3483-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003484option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3486option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3487option tcpka X X X X
3488option tcplog X X X X
3489option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003490external-check command X - X X
3491external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003492persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3493rate-limit sessions X X X -
3494redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003495-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003497retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003498server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003499server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003500server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003501source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003502srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3503srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3504srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003505stats admin - X X X
3506stats auth X X X X
3507stats enable X X X X
3508stats hide-version X X X X
3509stats http-request - X X X
3510stats realm X X X X
3511stats refresh X X X X
3512stats scope X X X X
3513stats show-desc X X X X
3514stats show-legends X X X X
3515stats show-node X X X X
3516stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003517-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3518stick match - - X X
3519stick on - - X X
3520stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003521stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003522stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003523tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003524tcp-check connect X - X X
3525tcp-check expect X - X X
3526tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003527tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003528tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003529tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003530tcp-check set-var X - X X
3531tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003532tcp-request connection - X X -
3533tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003534tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003535tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003536tcp-response content - - X X
3537tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538timeout check X - X X
3539timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003540timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003541timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003542timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3543timeout http-request X X X X
3544timeout queue X - X X
3545timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003546timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003548timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003549transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003550unique-id-format X X X -
3551unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003552use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003553use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003554use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003555------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3556 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3560---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561
3562This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3563
3564
3565acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3566 Declare or complete an access list.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 no | yes | yes | yes
3569 Example:
3570 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3571 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3572 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003574 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575
3576
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003577backlog <conns>
3578 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | yes | yes | no
3581 Arguments :
3582 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3583 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003584 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003585
3586 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3587 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3588 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3589 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3590 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3591 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3592 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3593 backlog parameter.
3594
3595 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3596 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3597 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3598
3599 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3600
3601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003603balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3606 yes | no | yes | yes
3607 Arguments :
3608 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3609 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3610 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3611 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3612
3613 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3614 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3615 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3616 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003617 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003618 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003619 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3620 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3621 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3622 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3623 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3624 it, so that you don't worry.
3625
3626 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3627 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3628 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3629 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3630 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3631 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3632 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3633 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003635 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3636 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3637 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3638 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3639 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3640 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3641 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003642 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3643 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3644 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003645
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003646 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003647 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003648 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3649 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003650 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003651 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3652 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3653 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3654 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3655 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003656 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3657 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3658 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3659 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3660 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3661 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003663 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3664 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3665 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3666 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3667 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3668 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3669 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3670 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003671 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003672 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003673 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3674 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3675 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003677 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3678 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3679 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3680 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3681 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3682 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3683 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3684 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3685 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3686 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3687 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3688 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003690 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003691 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3692 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3693 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3694 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3695 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3696 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3697 URIs start with a leading "/".
3698
3699 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3700 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3701 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3702 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3703
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003704 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3705 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3706 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3707 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003710 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3711
3712 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003713 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3714 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003715 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3716 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3717 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3718 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003719 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003720 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3721 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003722
3723 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3724 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3725 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3726 server will receive the request.
3727
3728 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3729 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3730 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3731 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3732 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003733 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3734 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3735 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003737 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3738 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3739 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3740 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3741 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003743 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003744 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3745 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3746 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3747
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003748 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3749 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3750 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3751
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003752 random
3753 random(<draws>)
3754 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003755 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3756 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3757 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3758 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003759 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3760 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3761 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3762 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3763 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3764 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3765 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3766 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3767 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3768 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3769 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3770 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3771 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3772 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3773 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3774 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3775 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3776 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3777 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3778 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003779
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003780 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003781 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003782 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3783 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3784 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3785 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3786 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3787 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003788 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003789 used instead.
3790
3791 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3792 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3793 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3794 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3795
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003796 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3797 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3798 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3799
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003800 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003801
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003803 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3804 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003805
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003806 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3807 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3808 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003809
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003810 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003811 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003812 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3813 NTLM relies on.
3814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003815 Examples :
3816 balance roundrobin
3817 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003818 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003819 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3820 balance hdr(host)
3821 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003822
3823 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3824 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003826 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003827 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3828 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3829 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003830 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003831
3832 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3833 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3834 defaults to 16 kB.
3835
3836 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3837 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3838
3839 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3840 Round Robin.
3841
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003842 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003843 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3844 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3845 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3846
3847 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3848
3849 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003850 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003851 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3852 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3853 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003855 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003856
3857
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003858bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3859bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 no | yes | yes | no
3863 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003864 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3865 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3866 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3867 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003868 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003869 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3870 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3871 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3872 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3873 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3874 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003875 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003876 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3877 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003878 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003879 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3880 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003881 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003882 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3883 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003884 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003885 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3886 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3887 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3888 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3889 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3890 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3891 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003892 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3893 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3894 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003895 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3896 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3897 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3898 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003899 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3900 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3901 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003902
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003903 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3904 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003905 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3906 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3907 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003908 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3909 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3910 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3911 the range.
3912
3913 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3914 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3915 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3916 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3917 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3918 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3919 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003920 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003921 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003923 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003924 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003925 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3926 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3927 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3928 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3929 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3930 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003932 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3933 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3934 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3935 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3938 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3939 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3940 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3941 in a frontend.
3942
3943 Example :
3944 listen http_proxy
3945 bind :80,:443
3946 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003947 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003948
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003949 listen http_https_proxy
3950 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003951 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003952
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003953 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3954 bind ipv6@:80
3955 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3956 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3957
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003958 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003959 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003960
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003961 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3962 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3963 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3964 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3965 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3966
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003967 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003968 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003969
3970
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003971bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003972 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3974 yes | yes | yes | yes
3975 Arguments :
3976 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3977 may be used to override a default value.
3978
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003979 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003980 option may be combined with other numbers.
3981
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003982 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003983 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3984 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3985 missing from all processes.
3986
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003987 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003988 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003989 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3990 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3991 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3992 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3993 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003994 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003995
3996 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3997 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3998 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3999 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4000 and 'even' instances.
4001
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004002 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4003 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4004 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4005 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004006
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004007 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4008 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4009
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004010 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4011 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4012 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4013
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004014 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4015 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4016
4017 Example :
4018 listen app_ip1
4019 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004020 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004021
4022 listen app_ip2
4023 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004024 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004025
4026 listen management
4027 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004028 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004029
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004030 listen management
4031 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4032 bind-process 1-4
4033
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004034 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004035
4036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037capture cookie <name> len <length>
4038 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 no | yes | yes | no
4041 Arguments :
4042 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4043 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4044 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4045 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004046 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
4048 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4049 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4050 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4051 right if it exceeds <length>.
4052
4053 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4054 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4055 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4056 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4057
4058 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4059 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4060 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4061
4062 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4063 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4064 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004065 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4066 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4067 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004068
4069 Example:
4070 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4071
4072 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004073 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004074
4075
4076capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004077 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 no | yes | yes | no
4080 Arguments :
4081 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004082 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004083 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4084 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4085 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4086
4087 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4088 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4089 it exceeds <length>.
4090
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004091 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004092 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4093 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004094 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4095 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4096 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4097 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004098 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004099 environments to find where the request came from.
4100
4101 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4102 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4103 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4104 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004105
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004106 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4107 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4108 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4109 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4110 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004111
4112 Example:
4113 capture request header Host len 15
4114 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004115 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004117 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118 about logging.
4119
4120
4121capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004122 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 no | yes | yes | no
4125 Arguments :
4126 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004127 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4129 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4130 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4131
4132 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4133 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4134 it exceeds <length>.
4135
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004136 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4138 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4139 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004140 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4141 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4142 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4143 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004145 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4146 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4147 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4148 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4149 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004150
4151 Example:
4152 capture response header Content-length len 9
4153 capture response header Location len 15
4154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004155 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156 about logging.
4157
4158
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004159clitcpka-cnt <count>
4160 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4161 the connection on the client side.
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | yes | yes | no
4164 Arguments :
4165 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4166
4167 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4168 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004169 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4170 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004171
4172 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4173
4174
4175clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4176 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4177 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4178 client side.
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments :
4182 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4183 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4184 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4185 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4186
4187 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4188 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004189 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4190 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004191
4192 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4193
4194
4195clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4196 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 yes | yes | yes | no
4199 Arguments :
4200 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4201 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4202 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4203 document.
4204
4205 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4206 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004207 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4208 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004209
4210 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4211
4212
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004213compression algo <algorithm> ...
4214compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004215compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004216 Enable HTTP compression.
4217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4218 yes | yes | yes | yes
4219 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004220 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4221 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4222 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4223
4224 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004225 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4226 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4227 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004228
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004229 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004230 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004231
4232 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4233 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4234 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4235 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4236 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004237 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004238
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004239 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4240 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4241 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4242 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4243 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4244 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4245 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004246 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004247
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004248 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004249 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004250 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4251 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4252 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4253 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4254 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004255
4256 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4257 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4258 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4259 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4260 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004261 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4262 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4263 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4264 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4265 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004266 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4267 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004268
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004269 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004270 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4271 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004272 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004273 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004274 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4275 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4276 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4277 "multipart"
4278 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4279 header
4280 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4281 and later
4282 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4283 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004284 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004285
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004286 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004287
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004288 Examples :
4289 compression algo gzip
4290 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004292
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004293cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004294 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4295 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004296 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | no | yes | yes
4300 Arguments :
4301 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4302 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4303 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4304 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4305 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4306 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004307 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4309 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4310
4311 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4312 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4313 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4314 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4315 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4316 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004317 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4318 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004319 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004320 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4321 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322
4323 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004324 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004325
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004326 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004327 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004328 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004329 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004330 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4331 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4332 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4333 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4334 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4335 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4336 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
4338 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4339 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4340 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4341 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4342 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4343 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4344 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4345 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4346 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004347 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004348 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4349 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4350 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004352 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4353 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4354 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004355 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4356 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4357 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4358 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004359 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4360 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4361 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004362
4363 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4364 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4365 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4366 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4367 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4368 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4369 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4370 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4371 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4372
4373 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4374 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4375 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4376 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4377 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4378 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4379 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4380 persistence cookie in the cache.
4381 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4382
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004383 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4384 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4385 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4386 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4387 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004388 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004389 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4390 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4391 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4392 they logout.
4393
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004394 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4395 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4396 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4397 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4398
4399 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4400 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4401 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4402 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4403 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4404 this attribute.
4405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004406 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004407 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004408 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4409 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4410 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4411 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4412 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4413 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004415 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4416 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4417 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4418 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4419 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4420 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4421 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4422 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004423 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004424 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4425 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4426 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4427 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4428 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4429 the site.
4430
4431 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4432 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4433 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4434 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4435 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4436 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4437 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4438 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4439 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4440 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4441 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4442 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4443 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004444 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004445 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4446 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4447
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004448 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4449 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4450 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4451 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4452 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4453 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4454
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004455 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4456 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4457 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4458 repeated.
4459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004460 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4461 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4462 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4463 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 Examples :
4466 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4467 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4468 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004469 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004471 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004473
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004474declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4475 Declares a capture slot.
4476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4477 no | yes | yes | no
4478 Arguments:
4479 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4480
4481 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4482 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4483 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4484 for use in the response.
4485
4486 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004487 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004488 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4489
4490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004491default-server [param*]
4492 Change default options for a server in a backend
4493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 yes | no | yes | yes
4495 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004496 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4497 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4498 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4499 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004500
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004501 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004502 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4503
4504 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507default_backend <backend>
4508 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4510 yes | yes | yes | no
4511 Arguments :
4512 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4513
4514 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4515 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4516 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4517 will catch all undetermined requests.
4518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519 Example :
4520
4521 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4522 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4523 default_backend dynamic
4524
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004525 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004527
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004528description <string>
4529 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 no | yes | yes | yes
4532 Arguments : string
4533
4534 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4535 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4536 it describes.
4537 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4538
4539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540disabled
4541 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 yes | yes | yes | yes
4544 Arguments : none
4545
4546 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4547 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4548 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4549 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4550 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4551 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4552 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4553
4554 See also : "enabled"
4555
4556
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004557dispatch <address>:<port>
4558 Set a default server address
4559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004561 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004562
4563 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4564 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4565 during start-up.
4566
4567 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4568 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4569 possible with normal servers.
4570
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004571 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004572 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4573 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4574 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4575 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4576
4577 See also : "server"
4578
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004579
4580dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4581 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | no | yes | yes
4584 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4585
4586 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004587 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004588 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4589 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004590 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004591 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004593enabled
4594 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | yes | yes | yes
4597 Arguments : none
4598
4599 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4600 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4601
4602 See also : "disabled"
4603
4604
4605errorfile <code> <file>
4606 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
4610 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004611 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004612 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004613
4614 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004615 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004616 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004617 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4618 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619
4620 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4621 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4622 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4623
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004624 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4625
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004626 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4627 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4628 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4629 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4630 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4631 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4632 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4633 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4634 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004636 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4637 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4638 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004639 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004640 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4641
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004642 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004643
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004644 Example :
4645 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004646 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004647 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4648 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4649
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004650
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004651errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4652 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4653 section.
4654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | yes | yes | yes
4656 Arguments :
4657 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4658
4659 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004660 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004661 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4662 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004663
4664 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4665 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4666 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4667 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4668 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004669 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004670 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4671
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004672 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4673 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004674
4675 Example :
4676 errorfiles generic
4677 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4678
4679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004680errorloc <code> <url>
4681errorloc302 <code> <url>
4682 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments :
4686 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004687 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004688 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004689
4690 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4691 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4692 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4693 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004694 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004695
4696 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4697 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4698 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4699
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004700 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4703 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4704 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4705 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004706 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4708 request.
4709
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004710 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004711
4712
4713errorloc303 <code> <url>
4714 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 yes | yes | yes | yes
4717 Arguments :
4718 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004719 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004720 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721
4722 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4723 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4724 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4725 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004726 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004727
4728 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4729 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4730 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4731
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004732 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004734 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4735 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4736 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4737 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004738 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004740 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004741
4742
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004743email-alert from <emailaddr>
4744 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004745 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748
4749 Arguments :
4750
4751 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4752
4753 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4754 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4755
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004756 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004757 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4758 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004759
4760
4761email-alert level <level>
4762 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4763 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4765 yes | yes | yes | yes
4766
4767 Arguments :
4768
4769 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4770 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4771 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4772
4773 By default level is alert
4774
4775 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4776 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4777 for the proxy.
4778
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004779 Alerts are sent when :
4780
4781 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4782 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4783 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4784 is notice or lower
4785 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4786 and a health check status update occurs
4787
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004788 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4789 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004790 section 3.6 about mailers.
4791
4792
4793email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4794 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | yes | yes | yes
4797
4798 Arguments :
4799
4800 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4801
4802 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4803 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4804
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004805 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4806 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004807
4808
4809email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4810 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4811 mailers.
4812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | yes | yes | yes
4814
4815 Arguments :
4816
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004817 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004818
4819 By default the systems hostname is used.
4820
4821 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4822 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4823 for the proxy.
4824
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004825 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4826 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004827
4828
4829email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004830 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004831 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 yes | yes | yes | yes
4834
4835 Arguments :
4836
4837 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4838
4839 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4840 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4841
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004842 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004843 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4844
4845
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004846force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4847 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004849 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004850
4851 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4852 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4853 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4854 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4855 marked down for maintenance operations.
4856
4857 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4858 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4859 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4860 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4861 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4862 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4863 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4864 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4865 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4866
4867 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4868 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4869 is used.
4870
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004871 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004872 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004873
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004874
4875filter <name> [param*]
4876 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | yes
4879 Arguments :
4880 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4881 referenced in section 9.
4882
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004883 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004884 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004885 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4886 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004887
4888 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4889 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4890
4891 Example:
4892 listen
4893 bind *:80
4894
4895 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4896 filter compression
4897 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4898
4899 compression algo gzip
4900 compression offload
4901
4902 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4903
4904 See also : section 9.
4905
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004907fullconn <conns>
4908 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
4911 Arguments :
4912 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4913 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4914
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004915 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004917 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004918 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4919 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4920 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4921 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4922 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004923 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004924
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004925 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4926 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004927 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4928 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4929 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004930
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931 Example :
4932 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4933 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4934 # connections.
4935 backend dynamic
4936 fullconn 10000
4937 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4938 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4939
4940 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4941
4942
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004943grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004944 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004946 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004947 Arguments :
4948 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4949 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4950 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4951
4952 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4953 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004954 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004955 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4956
4957 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4958 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4959 simplify it.
4960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004961
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004962hash-balance-factor <factor>
4963 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | no | no | yes
4966 Arguments :
4967 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4968 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004969 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004970
4971 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4972 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4973 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4974 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4975 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4976 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4977 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4978
4979 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4980 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4981 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4982 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4983 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4984
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004985 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4986 consistent hashing mechanism.
4987
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004988 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4989
4990
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004991hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004992 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | no | yes | yes
4995 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004996 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4997 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004998
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004999 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5000 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5001 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5002 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5003 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5004 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5005 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5006 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5007 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5008 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005009
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005010 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5011 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5012 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5013 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5014 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5015 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5016 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5017 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5018 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5019 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5020 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5021 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5022 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005023 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5024 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005025
5026 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5027
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005028 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005029 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5030 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5031 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005032 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5033 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5034 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005035
5036 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5037 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005038 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5039 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5040 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5041 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5042
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005043 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5044 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5045 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5046 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5047 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5048 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5049 parameter.
5050
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005051 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5052 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5053 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5054 used on strings.
5055
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005056 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5057
5058 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5059 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5060 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5061 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5062 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5063 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5064 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5065 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5066 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5067 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5068 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5069 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005070
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005071 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5072 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5073 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005074
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005075 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005076
5077
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005078http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5079 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5080 ones).
5081
5082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5083 no | yes | yes | yes
5084
5085 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5086 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5087 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5088 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5089 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5090 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5091
5092 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5093 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5094 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5095
5096 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5097 below.
5098
5099 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5100 instance.
5101
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005102 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5103 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5104 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5105
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005106 Example:
5107 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5108 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5109 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5110
5111http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5112
5113 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5114 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5115 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5116 example, or to pass some internal information.
5117 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5118 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5119 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5120
5121http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5122
5123 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5124 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005126http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005127
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005128 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5129 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5130 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5131 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5132 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005133
5134http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5135 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5136
5137 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5138
5139 Example:
5140 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5141
5142 # applied to:
5143 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5144
5145 # outputs:
5146 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5147
5148 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5149
5150http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5151 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5152
5153 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5154
5155 Example:
5156 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5157
5158 # applied to:
5159 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5160
5161 # outputs:
5162 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5163
5164http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5165
5166 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5167 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5168 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5169
5170http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5172
5173 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5174 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5175 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5176 fallback.
5177
5178 Example:
5179 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5180 http-response set-status 431
5181 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5182 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5183
5184http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185
5186 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5187 inline.
5188
5189 Arguments:
5190 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5191 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5192 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5193 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5194 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5195 (request and response)
5196 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5197 processing
5198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5199 processing
5200 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5201 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5202 and '_'.
5203
5204 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5205 followed by some converters.
5206
5207 Example:
5208 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5209
5210http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5211
5212 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5213 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5214 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5215 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5216 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005217 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005218 processing.
5219
5220 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5221 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005222 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005223 rules evaluation.
5224
5225http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5226
5227 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5228 details about <var-name>.
5229
5230 Example:
5231 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5232
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005233
5234http-check comment <string>
5235 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5236 it fails.
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 yes | no | yes | yes
5239
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005240 Arguments :
5241 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5242 rule fails.
5243
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005244 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5245 user-friendly error reporting.
5246
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005247 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005248 "http-check expect".
5249
5250
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005251http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5252 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005253 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005254 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | no | yes | yes
5257
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005258 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005259 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5260
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005261 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005262 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005263
5264 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5265 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5266 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5267 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5268
5269 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5270
5271 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5272
5273 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5274
5275 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5276
5277 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5278
5279 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5280 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5281 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5282 is used.
5283
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005284 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5285 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5286 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5287 haproxy -vv.
5288
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005289 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5290
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005291 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5292 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5293 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5294 different ports or with different servers.
5295
5296 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5297 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5298 the port with a "http-check connect".
5299
5300 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5301 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5302 do.
5303
5304 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5305 unset-var or comment rules.
5306
5307 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005308 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5309 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5310 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5311 option httpchk
5312
5313 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005314 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005315 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005316 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005317 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005318 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005319
5320 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5321
5322 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005323
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005325http-check disable-on-404
5326 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005328 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5332 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5333 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5334 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5335 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5336 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5337 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5338 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005339 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5340 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005341 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5342 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5343 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005345 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005346
5347
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005348http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005349 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5350 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5351 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005352 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005354 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005355
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005356 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005357 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5358
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005359 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5360 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5361 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5362 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5363 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5364 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5365 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5366 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5367 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5368 result is always conclusive.
5369
5370 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5371 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5372 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005373 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5374 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005375 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5376 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005377 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5378 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5379 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005380
5381 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5382 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005383 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5384 supported :
5385 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5386 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005387 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5388 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5389 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5390 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5391 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392
5393 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5394 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005395 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5396 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5397 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5398 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005399 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5400
5401 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5402 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5403 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5404 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5405
5406 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5407 informational message reported in logs if an error
5408 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5409 log-format string.
5410
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005411 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005412 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5413 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005414 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5415 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5416 details on the supported keywords.
5417
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005418 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5419 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5420 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5421 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005422
5423 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5424 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5425 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5426 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5427 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5428
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005429 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5430 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5431 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5432 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5433 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5434 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5435 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005436
5437 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005438 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005439 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5440 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5441 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5442 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5443
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005444 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5445 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005446 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5447 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5448 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5449 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5450 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5451 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5452 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5453 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005454 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5455 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5456 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5457 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5458 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5459 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5460 insensitive on the header names.
5461
5462 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5463 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5464 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5465 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5466 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5467 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005468
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005469 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005470 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005471 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5472 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5473 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5474 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5475 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005476 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005477 trace).
5478
5479 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005480 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005481 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5482 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5483 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5484 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5485 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005486 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005487
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005488 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5489 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5490 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5491 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5492 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5493 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5494
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005496 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005497 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5498 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5499 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5500 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5501 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5502 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5503
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005504 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5505 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5506 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5507 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5508 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005509
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005510 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5511 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5512
5513 Examples :
5514 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005515 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005516
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005517 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5518 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5519
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005520 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005521 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522
5523 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005524 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005525
5526 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005527 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005528
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005529 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005530 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005531
5532
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005533http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005534 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5535 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005536 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5537 health checks.
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | no | yes | yes
5540 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005541 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5542
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005543 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5544 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5545 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5546 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5547 to invent non-standard ones.
5548
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005549 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5550 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5551 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5552 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5553
5554 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5555 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5556 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5557 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005558
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005559 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005560 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005561 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005562 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5563 to add it.
5564
5565 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5566 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5567 to the log-format rules.
5568
5569 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5570 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5571 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005572
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005573 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5574 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5575 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5576 request.
5577
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005578 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5579 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5580 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005581 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5582 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5583 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5584 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005585 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005586
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005587 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005588 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5589 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005590
5591 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5592 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5593 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5594 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5595 configured request authority.
5596
5597 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5598 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005600 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005601
5602
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005603http-check send-state
5604 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | no | yes | yes
5607 Arguments : none
5608
5609 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5610 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5611 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5612 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5613 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5614
5615 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5616 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5617 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5618 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5619 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005620 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5621 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5622 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5623
5624 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5625 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5626 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5627
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005628 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5629 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5630 checked in multiple backends.
5631
5632 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5633 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5634
5635 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5636 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5637 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5638 one fails.
5639
5640 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5641 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5642 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5643
5644 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5645 server's queue.
5646
5647 Example of a header received by the application server :
5648 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5649 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5650
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005651 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5652 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005653
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654
5655http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005656 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
5659
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005660 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005661 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5662 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5663 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5664 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5665 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5667 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5668 and '-'.
5669
5670 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005672 Examples :
5673 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005674
5675
5676http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005677 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 yes | no | yes | yes
5680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005681 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005682 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5683 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5686 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5687 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5688 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5689 and '-'.
5690
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005691 Examples :
5692 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005695http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5696 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5697 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5698 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5699 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 yes | yes | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005703 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005704 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005705 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005706 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005707
5708 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5709 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5710 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5711 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5712
5713 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5714 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5715 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5716 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5717
5718 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5719 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5720 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5721 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5722 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5723 chroot is performed.
5724
5725 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5726 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5727 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5728 considered.
5729
5730 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5731 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5732 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5733 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5734 considered as a raw string.
5735
5736 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5737 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5738 "content-type".
5739
5740 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5741 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5742 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5743 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5744 evaluated as a log-format string.
5745
5746 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5747 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5748 argument to "content-type".
5749
5750 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5751 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5752 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5753 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5754
5755 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5756 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5757 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5758 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5759 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5760 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5761 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5762 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5763
5764 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5765 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5766 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5767
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005768 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5769 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5770 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5771 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5772 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5773
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005774 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5775 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5776
5777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005779 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5780
5781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 no | yes | yes | yes
5783
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005784 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5785 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5786 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5787 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5788 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5791 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005795 Example:
5796 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5797 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5798 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005800 http-request allow if nagios
5801 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5802 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5803 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 Example:
5806 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5807 acl add path /addacl
5808 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5813 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815 Example:
5816 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5817 acl setmap path /setmap
5818 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5823 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005825 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5826 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5831 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5832 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5833 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5834 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5835 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5836 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5837 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005841 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5842 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5843 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5844 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5845 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5846 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5847 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5848 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005852 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5853 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005854
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5859 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5860 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5861 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5862 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005863
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005864 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5865 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5866 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5867 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5868 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5869 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5870 instead.
5871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872 Example:
5873 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5874 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005876http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005877
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005878 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005879
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005880http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5881 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005883 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5884 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5885 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5886 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5887 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5888 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5889 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5890 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5891 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5894 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5895 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005896 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5897
5898 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5899 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5900 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5901 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5906 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5907 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5908 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5909 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5910 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005911
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005912http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005913
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005914 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5915 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5916 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5917 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5918 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5923 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5924 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5925 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5926 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5927 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005928
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005929http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5930http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5931 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5932 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5933 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5934 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005935
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005936 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5937 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5938 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005939 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005940 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5941 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5942 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005944 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005945
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005946http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5947 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5948 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5949 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5950
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005951http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5952
5953 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5954 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5955 pointed by <resolvers>.
5956 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5957 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5958 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5959 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5960 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5961 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5962 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5963 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5964 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5965 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5966 to 0.0.0.0.
5967
5968 Example:
5969 resolvers mydns
5970 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5971 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5972 timeout retry 1s
5973 hold valid 10s
5974 hold nx 3s
5975 hold other 3s
5976 hold obsolete 0s
5977 accepted_payload_size 8192
5978
5979 frontend fe
5980 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5981 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5982 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5983
5984 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5985 # which mean DNS resolution error
5986 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5987
5988 default_backend be
5989
5990 backend b_503
5991 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5992 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5993 # 503 error page to end users
5994
5995 backend be
5996 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5997 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5998 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5999 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6000 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6001
6002 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6003 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6004
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006005http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6006
6007 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6008 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6009 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6010 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006011 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6012 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006013
6014 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6015
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006016http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006017http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006018http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006019http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6021http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006022
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006023 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6024
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006025 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6026 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6027 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6028 processing in your infrastructure.
6029
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006030 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6031 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6032 the supported backend.
6033
6034 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6035 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6036 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6037 number of segments in the path.
6038
6039 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006040
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006041 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component.
6042
6043 Example:
6044 - /. -> /
6045 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6046 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6047 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
6048
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006049 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component.
6050 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
6051 their preceding segment. Empty segments do not receive special treatment.
6052 Use the "path-merge-slashes" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006053
6054 Example:
6055 - /foo/../ -> /
6056 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6057 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6058 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006059 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006060 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
6061
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006062 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6063 removed as well:
6064
6065 Example:
6066 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6067 - /bar/../../ -> /
6068
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006069 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6070 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006071
6072 Example:
6073 - // -> /
6074 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6075
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006076 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006077 (RFC 3986#6.2.21).
6078
6079 Example:
6080 - /%6f -> /%6F
6081 - /%zz -> /%zz
6082
6083 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6084 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6085
6086 Example:
6087 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6088
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006089 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006090 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6091 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6092
6093 Example:
6094 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6095 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6096 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6101 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6102 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6103 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6104 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006106http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006108 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6109 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6110 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6111 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6114 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006115
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006116 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006117 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6118 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6119 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6120 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6121 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006123 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6124 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6125 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6126 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6127 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006128
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006129 Example:
6130 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6131
6132 # applied to:
6133 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6134
6135 # outputs:
6136 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6137
6138 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006139
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006140 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6141
6142 # applied to:
6143 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006144
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006145 # outputs:
6146 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006147
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006148http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6150
6151 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6152 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006153 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6154 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6155 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006156
6157 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6158 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6159 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6163 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6164
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006165 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6166 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6167 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6168 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6169
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006170http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6172
6173 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6174 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6175 query-string are replaced.
6176
6177 Example:
6178 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6179 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6180
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006181http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6182 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6183
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006184 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6185 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6186 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6187 against.
6188
6189 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6190 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6191 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006192
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006193 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6194 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6195 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6196 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6197 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6198 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6199 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6200 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6201 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006202 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6203 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006204
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006205 Example:
6206 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6207 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006208
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006209 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6210 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006212http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006214
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006215 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6216 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6217 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6218 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006219
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006220 Example:
6221 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006222
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006223 # applied to:
6224 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006225
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006226 # outputs:
6227 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006228
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006229http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6230 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6231 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006232 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6234
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006236 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6237 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006238 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006239 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006240 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006241 are followed to create the response :
6242
6243 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6244 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6245 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6246 ignored.
6247
6248 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6249 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006250 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006251 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6252 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006253
6254 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6255 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6256 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006257 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6258 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006259
6260 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6261 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6262 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006263 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006264 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006265 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006266
6267 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6268 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6269 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6270 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6271 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6272 as a raw content.
6273
6274 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6275 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6276 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6277 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6278 considered as a raw string.
6279
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006280 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006281 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6282 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6283 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6284
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006285 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6286 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006287 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006288
6289 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6290
6291 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006292 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006293 if { path /ping }
6294
6295 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6296 if { path /favicon.ico }
6297
6298 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6299 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6300 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006302http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6303http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006305 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6306 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6307 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006308
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006309http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006311
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006312 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6313 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6314 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6315 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006317http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006319 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6320 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6321 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6322 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6323 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006325 Arguments:
6326 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6327 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006329 Example:
6330 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6331 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006333 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6334 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6339 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6340 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006342 Arguments:
6343 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6344 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346 Example:
6347 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6348 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6351 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6352 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006354http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6357 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6358 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6359 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6360 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006362 Example:
6363 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6364 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6365 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6366 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6367 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6368 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6369 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6370 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6371 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006373http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006375 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6376 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6377 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6378 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6379 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006381http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006384 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6385 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6386 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6387 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6388 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6389 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6390 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6391 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6392 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006394http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6397 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6398 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6399 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6400 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6401 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6402 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006404http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006406 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6407 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6408 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006410http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006412 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6413 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6414 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6415 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6416 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6417 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6418 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6419 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006421http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006423 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6424 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6425 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6426 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6427 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6428 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006430 Example :
6431 # prepend the host name before the path
6432 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006433
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006434http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6435
6436 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6437 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6438 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006440http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006442 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6443 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6444 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6445 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6446 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006448http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006450 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6451 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6452 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6453 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6454 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6455 values have higher priority.
6456 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6457 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6458 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6459 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6460 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006464 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6465 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6466 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6467 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6468 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6469 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6470 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006472 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006473
6474 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006475 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6476 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6480 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6481 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006482 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6483 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006484
6485 Arguments :
6486 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6487 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006488
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006489 See also "option forwardfor".
6490
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006491 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006492 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6493 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6494
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006495 # After the masking this will track connections
6496 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6497 http-request track-sc0 src
6498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006499 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6500 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6501
6502http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6503
6504 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6505 expression.
6506
6507 Arguments:
6508 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6509 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006510
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006511 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006512 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6513 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6514
6515 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6516 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6517 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6518
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006519http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6520 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6521
6522 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6523 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6524 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6525 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6526 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6527
6528 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6529 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6530 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6531 results.
6532
6533 Example:
6534 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6535 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6538
6539 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6540 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6541 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6542 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6543 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6544 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6545 information from the request.
6546
6547 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6548
6549http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6550
6551 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6552 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6553 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6554 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6555 path and the query string.
6556 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6557
6558http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6559
6560 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6561 inline.
6562
6563 Arguments:
6564 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6565 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6566 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6567 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6568 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6569 (request and response)
6570 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6571 processing
6572 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6573 processing
6574 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6575 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6576 and '_'.
6577
6578 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6579 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006580
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006581 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6585 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6588 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6589 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6590 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6591 agent name must be used.
6592
6593 Arguments:
6594 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6595
6596 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6597 configuration.
6598
6599http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6600
6601 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6602 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6603 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6604 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6605 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6606 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6607 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6608 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6609 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6610 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6611 action.
6612 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6613 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6614 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6615 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6616 you fully understand how it works.
6617
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006618http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6619
6620 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6621 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6622 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6623 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6624 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006625 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006626 processing.
6627
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006628 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006629 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6630 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6631 rules evaluation.
6632
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006633http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6634http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6635 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6636 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6637 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6638 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639
6640 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6641 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6642 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006643 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6644 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6645 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6646 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6647 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6648 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6649 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6650 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6651 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6652 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006653 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006654 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6655 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6656 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6657 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6658 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659
6660http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6661http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6662http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6663
6664 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6665 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6666 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6667 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006668 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6670 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6671 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6672 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6673 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6674 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6675 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6676
6677 Arguments :
6678 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6679 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6680 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6681 select which table entry to update the counters.
6682
6683 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6684 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6685 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6686 that table until the session ends.
6687
6688 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6689 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6690 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6691 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6692 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6693 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6694 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6695 useful information.
6696
6697 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6698 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6699 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6700 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6701 checks that make use of it.
6702
6703http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6704
6705 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006706
6707 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006709
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006710http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6711
6712 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6713 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6714 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6715 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6716 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6717 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6718
6719 Arguments :
6720 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6721
6722 Example:
6723 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6724
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006725http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6727
6728 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6729 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6730 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6731 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6732 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6733 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6734 http-buffer-request".
6735
6736 Arguments :
6737
6738 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6739 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6740
6741 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6742 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6743 bytes.
6744
6745 Example:
6746 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6747
6748 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006752 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6753 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6754 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006755
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006758 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6759
6760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 no | yes | yes | yes
6762
6763 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6764 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6765 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6766 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6767 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6768 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006770 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6771 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006773 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006775 Example:
6776 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006778 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006780 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6781 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006782
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006783 Example:
6784 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006786 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006788 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6789 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006791 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6792 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006794http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006796 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6797 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6798 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6799 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6800 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6801 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6802 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6803 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006805http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006807 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6808 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6809 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6810 example, or to pass some internal information.
6811 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6812 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6813 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006815http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006817 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6818 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006819
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006820http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006821
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006822 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006824http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006826 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6827 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6828 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6829 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6830 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6831 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6832 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006834 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6835 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6836 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6837 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6838 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006839
6840 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6841 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6842 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6843 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006845http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006847 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6848 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6849 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6850 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6851 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6852 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006853
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006854http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006855
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006856 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6857 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6858 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6859 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6860 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006862http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006864 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6865 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6866 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6867 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6868 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6869 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006870
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006871http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6872http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6873 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6874 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6875 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6876 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006877
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006878 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6879 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6880 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006881 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006882 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6883 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6884 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006885 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006886 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006888http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006890 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6891 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6892 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6893 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6894 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6895 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006897http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6898 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006899
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006900 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6901 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006903 Example:
6904 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006906 # applied to:
6907 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006909 # outputs:
6910 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006912 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006914http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6915 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006916
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006917 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006918 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006920 Example:
6921 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006923 # applied to:
6924 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006926 # outputs:
6927 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006928
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006929http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6930 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6931 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006932 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006933 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6934
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006935 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006936 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6937 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006938 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006939 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006940 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006941 are followed to create the response :
6942
6943 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6944 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6945 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6946 ignored.
6947
6948 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6949 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006950 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006951 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6952 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006953
6954 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6955 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6956 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006957 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6958 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006959
6960 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6961 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6962 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006963 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006964 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006965 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006966
6967 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6968 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6969 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6970 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6971 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6972 as a raw content.
6973
6974 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6975 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6976 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6977 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6978 considered as a raw string.
6979
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006980 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6981 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6982 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6983 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6984
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006985 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6986 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006987 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006988
6989 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6990
6991 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006992 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006993 if { status eq 404 }
6994
6995 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6996 string "This is the end !" \
6997 if { status eq 500 }
6998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006999http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7000http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007002 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7003 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7004 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007005
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007006http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7007 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007008
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007009 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7010 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7011 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7012 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7017 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7018 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7019 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7020 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022 Arguments:
7023 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007025 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7026 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007030 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7031 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7032 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7035
7036 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7037 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7038 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7039 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7040 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7041
7042http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7043
7044 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7045 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7046 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7047 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7048 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7049 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7050 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7051 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7052 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7053
7054http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7055
7056 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7057 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7058 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7059 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7060 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7061 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7062 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7063
7064http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7065
7066 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7067 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7068 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7069 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7070 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7071 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7072 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7073 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7074
7075http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7076 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7077
7078 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7079 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7080 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7081 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007082
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007083 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7085 http-response set-status 431
7086 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7087 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7092 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7093 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7094 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7095 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7096 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7097 based on some information from the request.
7098
7099 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7100
7101http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7102
7103 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7104 inline.
7105
7106 Arguments:
7107 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7108 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7109 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7110 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7111 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7112 (request and response)
7113 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7114 processing
7115 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7116 processing
7117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7118 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7119 and '_'.
7120
7121 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7122 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007123
7124 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007125 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007127http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007129 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7130 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7131 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7132 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7133 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7134 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7135 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7136 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7137 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7138 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7139 action.
7140 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7141 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7142 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7143 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7144 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007145
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007146http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7147
7148 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7149 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7150 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7151 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7152 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007153 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007154 processing.
7155
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007156 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007157 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007158 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007159 rules evaluation.
7160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7162http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7163http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007165 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7166 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7167 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7168 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7169 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7170 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7171
7172http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7173
7174 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7175 about <var-name>.
7176
7177 Example:
7178 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7179
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007180http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7181 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7182
7183 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7184 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7185 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7186 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7187 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7188 buffer is full.
7189
7190 Arguments :
7191
7192 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7193 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7194
7195 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7196 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7197 bytes.
7198
7199 Example:
7200 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007201
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007202http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7203 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7204
7205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7206 yes | no | yes | yes
7207
7208 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007209 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7210 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7211 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007212
7213 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7214
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007215 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7216 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7217 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7218 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7219 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7220 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7221 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7222 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7223 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7224 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007225
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007226 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7227 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7228 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7229 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7230 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7231 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7232 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007233 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7234 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7235 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7236 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7237 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7238 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007239
7240 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7241 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7242 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7243 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7244 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7245 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7246 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7247 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007248 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007249 downsides of rare connection failures.
7250
7251 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7252 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7253 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7254 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7255 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7256 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007257 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007258 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7259 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7260 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7261 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7262 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7263
7264 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007265 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7266 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7267 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7268 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007269
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007270 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7271 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007272
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007273 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007274
7275 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7276 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7277 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7278
7279 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7280
7281
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007282http-send-name-header [<header>]
7283 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7285 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007286 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007287 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7288
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007289 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7290 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7291 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7292 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7293 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7294 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7295 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7296 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7297 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7298 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7299 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7300 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7301 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7302 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7303 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7304 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007305
7306 See also : "server"
7307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007308id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007309 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7311 no | yes | yes | yes
7312 Arguments : none
7313
7314 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7315 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7316 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007317
7318
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007319ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7320 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007322 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007323
7324 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7325 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7326 and running).
7327
7328 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7329 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7330 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007331 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007332 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007334 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7335 "unless" condition is met.
7336
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007337 Example:
7338 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7339 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7340 ignore-persist if url_static
7341
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007342 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7343
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007344load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7345 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7347 yes | no | yes | yes
7348
7349 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7350 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7351 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007352 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007353 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7354 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7355 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7356 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7357
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007358 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007359 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007360 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007361
7362 Arguments:
7363 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7364 named "server-state-file".
7365
7366 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7367 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7368 name is used as a file name.
7369
7370 none don't load any stat for this backend
7371
7372 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007373 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7374 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7375 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007376 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007377 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007378
7379 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7380 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007382 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007383
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007384 global
7385 stats socket /tmp/socket
7386 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007387
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007388 defaults
7389 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007390
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007391 backend bk
7392 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7393 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007394
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007395
7396 Then one can run :
7397
7398 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7399
7400 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7401
7402 1
7403 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7404 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7405 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7406
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007407 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007408
7409 global
7410 stats socket /tmp/socket
7411 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7412
7413 defaults
7414 load-server-state-from-file local
7415
7416 backend bk
7417 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7418 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7419
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007420
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007421 Then one can run :
7422
7423 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7424
7425 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7426
7427 1
7428 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7429 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7430 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7431
7432 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7433 "show servers state"
7434
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007435
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007436log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007437log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007438 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007439no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007440 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007443
7444 Prefix :
7445 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7446 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7447 prefix does not allow arguments.
7448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007449 Arguments :
7450 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7451 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7452 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7453 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7454 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7455 parameter.
7456
7457 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7458 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7459
7460 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7461 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7462 standard syslog port).
7463
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007464 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7465 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7466 standard syslog port).
7467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007468 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7469 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7470 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007471 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007472
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007473 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7474 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7475 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7476 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7477 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7478 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7479 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7480 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7481 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7482 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7483 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7484 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7485 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7486 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7487 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7488 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007489 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7490 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007491
7492 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7493 and "fd@2", see above.
7494
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007495 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7496 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7497 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7498 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7499 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7500 having the logs instantly available.
7501
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007502 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7503 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7504 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7505
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007506 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7507 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007508
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007509 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7510 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7511 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7512 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7513 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7514 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7515 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7516 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7517 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7518 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007520
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007521 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7522 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7523 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7524 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7525 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7526
7527 <sample_size>
7528 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7529 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7530 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7531 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7532 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7533
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007534 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7535 one of the following :
7536
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007537 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7538 field is stripped. This is the default.
7539 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7540 rfc3164.
7541
7542 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007543 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7544
7545 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7546 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7547
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007548 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7549 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7550 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7551 designed to be used with a local log server.
7552
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007553 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7554 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7555 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7556 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7557 systemd logger consumes.
7558
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007559 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7560 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7561 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7562 used with a local log server.
7563
7564 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7565 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7566 designed to be used with a local log server.
7567
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007568 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7569 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7570 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7571 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007573 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7574
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007575 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7576 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7577 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7578
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007579 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7580 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7581 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7582 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007583
7584 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7585 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7586 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007587 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7588 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7589 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7590 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7591 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007592
7593 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7594
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007595 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7596 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7597 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007598
7599 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7600 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7601 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7602 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7603
7604 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7605 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007606
7607 Example :
7608 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007609 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7610 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7611 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007612 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007613 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7614 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007615 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007616
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007618log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007619 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007622
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007623 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7624 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7625 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7626 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7627 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007628
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007629 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7630 "option httplog" directives.
7631
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007632log-format-sd <string>
7633 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 yes | yes | yes | no
7636
7637 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7638 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7639 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7640 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7641 which covers the log format string in depth.
7642
7643 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7644 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7645
7646 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7647 log format to "rfc5424".
7648
7649 Example :
7650 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7651
7652
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007653log-tag <string>
7654 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7656 yes | yes | yes | yes
7657
7658 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7659 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7660 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7661 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7662 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7663 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7664 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7665 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7666 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007667
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007668max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7669 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7670 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7671 yes | no | yes | yes
7672
7673 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7674 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7675 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7676 servers.
7677
7678 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7679 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7680 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7681 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7682 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007683 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007684 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7685 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7686 picking a different server.
7687
7688 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7689 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7690 even if they have to be queued.
7691
7692 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7693 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7694
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007695max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7696 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7697 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7698 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007700maxconn <conns>
7701 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7703 yes | yes | yes | no
7704 Arguments :
7705 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7706 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7707 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7708 closes.
7709
7710 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7711 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7712 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7713 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007714 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7715 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7716 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7717 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007718
7719 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7720 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7721 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7722
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007723 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7724 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007726 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7727
7728
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007729mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007730 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | yes | yes | yes
7733 Arguments :
7734 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7735 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7736 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7737 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7738
7739 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7740 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7741 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7742 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7743 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7744
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007745 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7746 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7747 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007749 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007750 defaults http_instances
7751 mode http
7752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007753
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007754monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007755 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7757 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007758 Arguments :
7759 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7760 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007761 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007762 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7763 backend and its backup.
7764
7765 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7766 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7767 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7768 servers in a list of backends.
7769
7770 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7771 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7772 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7773 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7774 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7775 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7776 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007777 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7778 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007779
7780 Example:
7781 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007782 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007783 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7784 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7785 monitor-uri /site_alive
7786 monitor fail if site_dead
7787
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007788 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007789
7790
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007791monitor-uri <uri>
7792 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 yes | yes | yes | no
7795 Arguments :
7796 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7797 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7798
7799 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7800 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7801 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7802 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7803 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7804 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7805 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7806 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7807
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007808 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007809 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7810 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7811 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7812 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7813 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7814 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007815
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007816 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7817 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7818 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7819 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7820
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007821 Example :
7822 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7823 frontend www
7824 mode http
7825 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7826
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007827 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007829
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007830option abortonclose
7831no option abortonclose
7832 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7834 yes | no | yes | yes
7835 Arguments : none
7836
7837 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7838 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7839 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7840 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007841 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007842 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7843 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7844 encountered while delivering the response.
7845
7846 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7847 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7848 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7849 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7850 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7851 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007852 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007853 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007854 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007855 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7856 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7857 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7858
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007859 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7860 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007861 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7862 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7863 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7864 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7865 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7866 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007867 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007868
7869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7871
7872 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7873
7874
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007875option accept-invalid-http-request
7876no option accept-invalid-http-request
7877 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7879 yes | yes | yes | no
7880 Arguments : none
7881
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007882 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007883 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007884 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007885 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7886 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7887 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7888 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7889 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007890 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7891 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7892 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7893 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007894 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007895 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007896 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7897 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7898 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007899
7900 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7901 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7902 been confirmed.
7903
7904 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7905 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007906 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7907 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007908 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7909
7910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7912
7913 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7914 stats socket.
7915
7916
7917option accept-invalid-http-response
7918no option accept-invalid-http-response
7919 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 yes | no | yes | yes
7922 Arguments : none
7923
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007924 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007925 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007926 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007927 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7928 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7929 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7930 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7931 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007932 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7933 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7934 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007935
7936 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7937 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7938 been confirmed.
7939
7940 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7941 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7942 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7943 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7944
7945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7947
7948 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7949 stats socket.
7950
7951
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007952option allbackups
7953no option allbackups
7954 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | no | yes | yes
7957 Arguments : none
7958
7959 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7960 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7961 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7962 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7963 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7964 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7965 order between the backup servers anymore.
7966
7967 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7968 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7969
7970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7972
7973
7974option checkcache
7975no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007976 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7978 yes | no | yes | yes
7979 Arguments : none
7980
7981 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7982 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007983 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007984 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7985 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007986 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007987
7988 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007989 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007990 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007991 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7992 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007993 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007994 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007995 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7996 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007997 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007998 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7999 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008000 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008001 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8002 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8003 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8004 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8005 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8006 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8007 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8008 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8009 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8010
8011 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008012 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8013 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8014 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8015 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008016
8017 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8018 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008019 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008021
8022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8024
8025
8026option clitcpka
8027no option clitcpka
8028 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 yes | yes | yes | no
8031 Arguments : none
8032
8033 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8034 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008035 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008036 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8037
8038 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8039 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8040 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8041 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8042
8043 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8044 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8045 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8046 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8047 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8048
8049 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8050
8051 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8052 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8053 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8054
8055 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8056 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8057
8058 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8059
8060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008061option contstats
8062 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8064 yes | yes | yes | no
8065 Arguments : none
8066
8067 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8068 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8069 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8070 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008071 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8072 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8073 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8074 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8075 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008077option disable-h2-upgrade
8078no option disable-h2-upgrade
8079 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8080 connection.
8081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8082 yes | yes | yes | no
8083 Arguments : none
8084
8085 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8086 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8087 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8088 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008089 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8090 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8091 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8092 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8093 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8094 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008095
8096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008098
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008099option dontlog-normal
8100no option dontlog-normal
8101 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8103 yes | yes | yes | no
8104 Arguments : none
8105
8106 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8107 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8108 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8109 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8110 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8111 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8112 logged.
8113
8114 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8115 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8116 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008118 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008119 logging.
8120
8121
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008122option dontlognull
8123no option dontlognull
8124 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 yes | yes | yes | no
8127 Arguments : none
8128
8129 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8130 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8131 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8132 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8133 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8134 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008135 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8136 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8137 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008138
8139 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008140 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008141 would not be logged.
8142
8143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8145
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008146 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008147 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008148
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008149
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008150option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008151 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8153 yes | yes | yes | yes
8154 Arguments :
8155 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8156 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008157 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008158 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008159
8160 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8161 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8162 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8163 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8164 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8165 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8166 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008167 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8168 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8169 possible that the client has already brought one.
8170
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008171 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008172 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008173 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008174 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008175 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008176 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008177
8178 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8179 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8180 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8181 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8182 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8183 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008184 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008185
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008186 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8187 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8188 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8189 are under the control of the end-user.
8190
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008191 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008192 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8193 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008194 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8195 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8196 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008198 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008199 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8200 frontend www
8201 mode http
8202 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8203
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008204 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8205 backend www
8206 mode http
8207 option forwardfor header X-Client
8208
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008209 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008210 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008211
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008212
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008213option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8214no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8215 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | yes | yes | no
8218 Arguments : none
8219
8220 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8221 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8222 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8223 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8224 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8225 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8226 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8227
8228 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8229 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8230 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8231 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8232 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8233 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8234 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8235 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8236 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8237 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8238
8239 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8240
8241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8243
8244 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8245 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8246
8247
8248option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8249no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8250 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8252 yes | no | yes | yes
8253 Arguments : none
8254
8255 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8256 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8257 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8258 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8259 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8260 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8261 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8262
8263 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8264 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8265 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8266 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8267 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8268 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8269 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8270 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8271 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8272 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8273
8274 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8275
8276 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8277 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8278
8279 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8280 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8281
8282
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008283option http-buffer-request
8284no option http-buffer-request
8285 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8287 yes | yes | yes | yes
8288 Arguments : none
8289
8290 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8291 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8292 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8293 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8294 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8295 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008296 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8297 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8298 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8299 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008300
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008301 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8302 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008303
8304
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008305option http-ignore-probes
8306no option http-ignore-probes
8307 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8309 yes | yes | yes | no
8310 Arguments : none
8311
8312 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8313 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8314 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8315 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8316 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8317 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8318 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8319 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8320 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008321 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8322 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008323 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8324
8325 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8326 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8327 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8328 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8329 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8330 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8331 are often the only way to detect them.
8332
8333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8335
8336 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8337
8338
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008339option http-keep-alive
8340no option http-keep-alive
8341 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | yes | yes | yes
8344 Arguments : none
8345
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008346 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8347 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008348 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8349 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008350 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8351 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8352 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008353
8354 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8355 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008356 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8357 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8358 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8359 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8360 situations where this option may be useful :
8361
8362 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008364
8365 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8366 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8367
8368 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8369 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8370 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8371 request.
8372
8373 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8374 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008375 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8376 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8377 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008378
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008379 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8380 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8381 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8382 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8383 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8384 not set.
8385
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008386 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8387 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8388 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008389
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008390 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008391 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008392 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008393
8394
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008395option http-no-delay
8396no option http-no-delay
8397 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8399 yes | yes | yes | yes
8400 Arguments : none
8401
8402 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8403 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8404 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8405 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8406 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8407 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8408 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8409 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8410 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8411 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8412 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8413 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8414 affected.
8415
8416 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8417 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8418 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8419 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8420 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8421 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8422 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8423 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8424 latency environments.
8425
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008426 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8427
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008428
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008429option http-pretend-keepalive
8430no option http-pretend-keepalive
8431 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008433 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008434 Arguments : none
8435
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008436 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008437 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8438 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8439 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8440 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8441 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8442 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8443 consider the response complete.
8444
8445 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8446 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8447 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8448 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008449 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008450 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8451
8452 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8453 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8454 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8455 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8456 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8457 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8458 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8459
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008460 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8461 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8462 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8463 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8464 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8465 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008466
8467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8469
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008470 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008471 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008472
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008473
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008474option http-server-close
8475no option http-server-close
8476 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8478 yes | yes | yes | yes
8479 Arguments : none
8480
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008481 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8482 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8483 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8484 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008485 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8486 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8487 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8488 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8489 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8490 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8491 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8492 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8493 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8494 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8495 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008496
8497 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8498 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8499 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8500 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008501 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8502 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008503
8504 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8505 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008506 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8507 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8508 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008509
8510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8512
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008513 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8514 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008515
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008516option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008517no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008518 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 yes | yes | yes | no
8521 Arguments : none
8522
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008523 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008524 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8525 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8526 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8527 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8528 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8529 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8530
8531 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8532 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008533 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8534 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8535 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008536
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008537 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8538 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8539 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8540 front of an existing proxy.
8541
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008542 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8543
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008544 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008545
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008546option httpchk
8547option httpchk <uri>
8548option httpchk <method> <uri>
8549option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008550 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | no | yes | yes
8553 Arguments :
8554 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8555 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8556 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8557 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8558 ones.
8559
8560 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8561 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8562 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8563
8564 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8565 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8566 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008567 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008568
8569 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8570 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8571 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8572 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8573 the lack of any response.
8574
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008575 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8576 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8577 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8578 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8579
8580 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8581 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8582 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008583
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008584 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8585 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008586 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008587 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008588 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008589
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008590 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8591 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8592 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8593 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8594
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008595 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008596 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8597 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8598 backend https_relay
8599 mode tcp
8600 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8601 http-check send hdr Host www
8602 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008603
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008604 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8605 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8606 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008607
8608
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008609option httpclose
8610no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008611 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8613 yes | yes | yes | yes
8614 Arguments : none
8615
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008616 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8617 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8618 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8619 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008620 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008621
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008622 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8623 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008624 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008625 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8626 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008627
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008628 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8629 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8630 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008631
8632 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8633 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008634 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8635 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8636 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008637
8638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8640
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008641 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008642
8643
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008644option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008645 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008647 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008648 Arguments :
8649 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8650 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8651 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008653 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008654
8655 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8656 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8657 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8658 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8659 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8660 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8661 ports.
8662
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008663 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8664 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008665
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008666 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008668 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008669
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008670
8671option http_proxy
8672no option http_proxy
8673 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8675 yes | yes | yes | yes
8676 Arguments : none
8677
8678 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8679 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8680 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8681 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8682 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8683
8684 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8685 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008686 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8687 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008688
8689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8691
8692 Example :
8693 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8694 backend direct_forward
8695 option httpclose
8696 option http_proxy
8697
8698 See also : "option httpclose"
8699
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008700
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008701option independent-streams
8702no option independent-streams
8703 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8705 yes | yes | yes | yes
8706 Arguments : none
8707
8708 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8709 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8710 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8711 receive data or not.
8712
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008713 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008714 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8715 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8716 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8717 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8718 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8719 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8720 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8721 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8722 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8723 socket buffers.
8724
8725 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8726 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8727 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8728 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8729 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8730
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008731 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008732
8733
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008734option ldap-check
8735 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8737 yes | no | yes | yes
8738 Arguments : none
8739
8740 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8741 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8742 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8743 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8744
8745 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8746 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8747
8748 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8749 configure it.
8750
8751 Example :
8752 option ldap-check
8753
8754 See also : "option httpchk"
8755
8756
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008757option external-check
8758 Use external processes for server health checks
8759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8760 yes | no | yes | yes
8761
8762 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8763 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8764 command".
8765
8766 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8767
8768 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8769
8770
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008771option log-health-checks
8772no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008773 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8775 yes | no | yes | yes
8776 Arguments : none
8777
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008778 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8779 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8780 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008781
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008782 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8783 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8784 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8785 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8786 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008788 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008789 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008790
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008791 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8792 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8793 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008794
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008795
8796option log-separate-errors
8797no option log-separate-errors
8798 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 yes | yes | yes | no
8801 Arguments : none
8802
8803 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8804 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8805 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8806 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8807 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8808 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8809 provides very important information.
8810
8811 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8812 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8813 error logs.
8814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008815 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008816 logging.
8817
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008818
8819option logasap
8820no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008821 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | yes | yes | no
8824 Arguments : none
8825
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008826 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8827 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8828 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8829 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8830
8831 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8832 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8833 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8834 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8835 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008836 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008837 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8838 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8839 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8840 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008841 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008843 Examples :
8844 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8845 mode http
8846 option httplog
8847 option logasap
8848 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8849
8850 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8851 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8852 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8853 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008855 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008856 logging.
8857
8858
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008859option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008860 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8862 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008863 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008864 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8865 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008866 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8867 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008868
8869 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8870 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008872 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8873 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8874 in the MySQL table, like this :
8875
8876 USE mysql;
8877 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8878 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8879
8880 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008881 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008882 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8883 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8884 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8885 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8886 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8887 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8888 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8889
8890 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8891 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008892
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008893 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008894
8895 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8896 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8897 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8898 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008899 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8900 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008901
8902 See also: "option httpchk"
8903
8904
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008905option nolinger
8906no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008907 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8909 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008910 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008911
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008912 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008913 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8914 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8915 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8916 connections.
8917
8918 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8919 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008920 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8921 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8922 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8923 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8924 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8925 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8926 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8927 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8928 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8929 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8930 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8931 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8932 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008933
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008934 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8935 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8936 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8937 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8938 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008939
8940 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8941 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008942 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008943 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008944 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008945
8946 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8947 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8948
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008949 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8950 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008951
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008952option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8953 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8955 yes | yes | yes | yes
8956 Arguments :
8957 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8958 matching <network>
8959 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8960 header name.
8961
8962 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8963 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8964 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8965 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8966 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8967 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8968 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8969 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8970 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8971 possible that the client has already brought one.
8972
8973 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8974 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8975 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8976 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8977 header and requires different one.
8978
8979 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8980 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8981 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008982 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8983 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8984 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8985 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8986 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008987
8988 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8989 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8990 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8991 both are defined.
8992
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008993 Examples :
8994 # Original Destination address
8995 frontend www
8996 mode http
8997 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8998
8999 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9000 backend www
9001 mode http
9002 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9003
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009004 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009005
9006
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009007option persist
9008no option persist
9009 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009012 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009013
9014 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9015 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9016 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9017 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9018 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9019 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9020 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9021 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9022 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9023 redirected to another valid server.
9024
9025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9027
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009028 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009029
9030
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009031option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9032 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 yes | no | yes | yes
9035 Arguments :
9036 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9037 PostgreSQL server.
9038
9039 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9040 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9041 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9042 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9043
9044 See also: "option httpchk"
9045
9046
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009047option prefer-last-server
9048no option prefer-last-server
9049 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | no | yes | yes
9052 Arguments : none
9053
9054 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9055 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9056 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9057 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9058 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9059 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9060 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9061 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9062 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009063 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9064 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009065 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9066 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9067 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009068 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9069 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9070 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009071
9072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9074
9075 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9076
9077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009078option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009079option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009080no option redispatch
9081 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9083 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009084 Arguments :
9085 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9086 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9087 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009088 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009089 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009090 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009091 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9092 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9093 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009095
9096 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9097 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9098 be able to access the service anymore.
9099
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009100 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9101 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009102
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009103 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9104 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9105 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9106 following order:
9107
9108 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9109
9110 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9111 list, or
9112
9113 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9114
9115 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9116 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9117
9118 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9119 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9120 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9121 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9122
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009123 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009124 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9125 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9129
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009130 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009131
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009132
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009133option redis-check
9134 Use redis health checks for server testing
9135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9136 yes | no | yes | yes
9137 Arguments : none
9138
9139 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9140 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9141 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9142 find the "+PONG" response message.
9143
9144 Example :
9145 option redis-check
9146
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009147 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009148
9149
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009150option smtpchk
9151option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9152 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009155 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009156 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009157 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009158 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9159
9160 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9161 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9162 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9163
9164 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9165 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9166 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9167 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9168 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9169 dead server.
9170
9171 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9172 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009174 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9175
9176 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9177 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9178 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9179 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009180 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009181
9182 Example :
9183 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9184
9185 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009188option socket-stats
9189no option socket-stats
9190
9191 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 yes | yes | yes | no
9194
9195 Arguments : none
9196
9197
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009198option splice-auto
9199no option splice-auto
9200 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9202 yes | yes | yes | yes
9203 Arguments : none
9204
9205 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9206 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009207 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009208 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009209 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009210 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9211 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9212 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9213 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9214
9215 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9216 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9217 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9218 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9219 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9220 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9221 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9222 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9223 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9224 keyword.
9225
9226 Example :
9227 option splice-auto
9228
9229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9231
9232 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9233 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9234
9235
9236option splice-request
9237no option splice-request
9238 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9240 yes | yes | yes | yes
9241 Arguments : none
9242
9243 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009244 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009245 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9246 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9247 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9248 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9249
9250 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9251
9252 Example :
9253 option splice-request
9254
9255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9257
9258 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9259 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9260
9261
9262option splice-response
9263no option splice-response
9264 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9266 yes | yes | yes | yes
9267 Arguments : none
9268
9269 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009270 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009271 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9272 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9273 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9274 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9275
9276 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9277
9278 Example :
9279 option splice-response
9280
9281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9283
9284 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9285 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9286
9287
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009288option spop-check
9289 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 no | no | no | yes
9292 Arguments : none
9293
9294 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9295 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9296 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9297 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9298
9299 Example :
9300 option spop-check
9301
9302 See also : "option httpchk"
9303
9304
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009305option srvtcpka
9306no option srvtcpka
9307 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9309 yes | no | yes | yes
9310 Arguments : none
9311
9312 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9313 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009314 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009315 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9316
9317 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9318 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9319 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9320 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9321
9322 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9323 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9324 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9325 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9326 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9327
9328 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9329
9330 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9331 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9332 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9333
9334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9336
9337 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9338
9339
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009340option ssl-hello-chk
9341 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | no | yes | yes
9344 Arguments : none
9345
9346 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9347 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9348 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9349 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9350 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9351 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9352 hello message.
9353
9354 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9355 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9356 messages, which is appreciable.
9357
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009358 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9359 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9360 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009361
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009362 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9363
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009364
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009365option tcp-check
9366 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9368 yes | no | yes | yes
9369
9370 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9371 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9372
9373 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9374 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9375 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9376
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009377 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009378 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9379 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9380 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9381 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9382 only.
9383
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009384 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009385 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9386 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9387 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9388 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9389
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009390 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9392 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009393 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009394 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9395 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9396 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9397 the respective protocols.
9398 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009399 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009400
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009401 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009402
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009403 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9404 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9405 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9406 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009407
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009408 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9409 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9410 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009411
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009412
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009413 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009414 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009415 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009416 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009418 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009419 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009420 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009421
9422 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9423 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009424 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009425 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009426 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009427 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009428 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009429 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009430 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9431 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009432 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009433 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9434 tcp-check expect string +OK
9435
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009436 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009437 (send many headers before analyzing)
9438 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009439 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009440 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9441 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9442 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9443 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009444 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009445
9446
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009447 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009448
9449
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009450option tcp-smart-accept
9451no option tcp-smart-accept
9452 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9454 yes | yes | yes | no
9455 Arguments : none
9456
9457 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9458 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9459 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9460 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9461 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9462 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9463
9464 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9465 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9466 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9467 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9468
9469 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9470 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9471 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009472 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009473
9474 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9475 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9476 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9477
9478 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9479 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9480 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9481
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009482 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9483
9484
9485option tcp-smart-connect
9486no option tcp-smart-connect
9487 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9489 yes | no | yes | yes
9490 Arguments : none
9491
9492 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9493 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9494 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9495 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9496 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9497
9498 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9499 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9500 complex.
9501
9502 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9503 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9504 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9505
9506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9508
9509 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9510
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009511
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009512option tcpka
9513 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 yes | yes | yes | yes
9516 Arguments : none
9517
9518 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9519 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009520 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009521 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9522
9523 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9524 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9525 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9526 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9527
9528 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9529 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9530 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9531 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9532 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9533
9534 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9535
9536 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9537 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9538 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9539 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9540 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9541 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9542 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9543 backends.
9544
9545 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9546
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009547
9548option tcplog
9549 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009551 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009552 Arguments : none
9553
9554 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9555 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9556 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9557 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9558 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9559 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9560 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9561 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9562
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009563 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009565 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009566
9567
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009568option transparent
9569no option transparent
9570 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009572 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009573 Arguments : none
9574
9575 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9576 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9577 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9578 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9579 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9580 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9581 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9582 appropriate server.
9583
9584 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9585 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9586
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009587 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009588 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009589
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009590
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009591external-check command <command>
9592 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9594 yes | no | yes | yes
9595
9596 Arguments :
9597 <command> is the external command to run
9598
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009599 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9600
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009601 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009602
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009603 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9604 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9605 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9606 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9607 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9608 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009609
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009610 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9611
9612 Environment variables :
9613 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9614 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9615
9616 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9617
9618 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9619
9620 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9621 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9622 for a UNIX socket).
9623
9624 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9625
9626 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9627
9628 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9629
9630 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9631
9632 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9633
9634 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9635 socket).
9636
9637 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9638 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9639
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009640 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9641
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009642 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9643 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9644 failed.
9645
9646 Example :
9647 external-check command /bin/true
9648
9649 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9650
9651
9652external-check path <path>
9653 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9655 yes | no | yes | yes
9656
9657 Arguments :
9658 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9659
9660 The default path is "".
9661
9662 Example :
9663 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9664
9665 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9666 "external-check command"
9667
9668
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009669persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009670persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009671 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments :
9675 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009676 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9677 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009678
9679 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9680 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009682 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9683 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9684 forwarded to this server.
9685
9686 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9687 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9688 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009689 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009690 a single "listen" section.
9691
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009692 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9693 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9694 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9695
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009696 Example :
9697 listen tse-farm
9698 bind :3389
9699 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9700 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9701 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9702 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9703 persist rdp-cookie
9704 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009705 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009706 balance rdp-cookie
9707 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9708 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9709
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009710 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9711 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009712
9713
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009714rate-limit sessions <rate>
9715 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9717 yes | yes | yes | no
9718 Arguments :
9719 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9720 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9721
9722 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9723 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9724 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9725 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9726 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9727 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9728
9729 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9730 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9731 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9732 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9733
9734 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9735 listen smtp
9736 mode tcp
9737 bind :25
9738 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009739 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009740
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009741 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9742 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9743 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009744
9745 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9746
9747
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009748redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9749redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9750redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009751 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9753 no | yes | yes | yes
9754
9755 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009756 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009757
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009759 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009760 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9761 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9762 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009763
9764 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9765 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9766 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9767 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9768 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009769 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9770 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9771 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9772 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009773
9774 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9775 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9776 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9777 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9778 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9779 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009780 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009781 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009782 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9783 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9784 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009785
9786 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009787 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9788 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9789 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009790 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009791 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9792 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9793 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9794 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009795
9796 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009797 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009798
9799 - "drop-query"
9800 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9801 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9802 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9803 with a location-type redirect.
9804
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009805 - "append-slash"
9806 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9807 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9808 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9809 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9810
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009811 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9812 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9813 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9814 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9815 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9816 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9817 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9818
9819 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9820 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9821 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9822 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9823 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9824 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9825 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009826
9827 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9828 acl clear dst_port 80
9829 acl secure dst_port 8080
9830 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009831 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009832 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009833 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9834
9835 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009836 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9837 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9838 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009839 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009840
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009841 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9842 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9843 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9844
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009845 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009846 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009847
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009848 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009849 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9850 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9851 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009853 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009854
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009855
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009856retries <value>
9857 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9859 yes | no | yes | yes
9860 Arguments :
9861 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9862 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9863 default value is 3.
9864
9865 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9866 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9867 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9868
9869 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009870 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9871 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009872
9873 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9874 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9875
9876 See also : "option redispatch"
9877
9878
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009879retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009880 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9881 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9882 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9884 yes | no | yes | yes
9885 Arguments :
9886 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9887 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9888 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9889 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9890
9891 none never retry
9892
9893 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9894 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9895
9896 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9897 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9898 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9899 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9900 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9901 processing the request.
9902
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009903 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9904 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9905 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9906 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9907 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9908 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9909 overflow attack for example).
9910
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009911 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9912 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9913 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9914 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9915 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9916 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9917 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9918 amplify denial of service attacks.
9919
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009920 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9921 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9922 considered to be safe to retry.
9923
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009924 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9925 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9926 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9927 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9928 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009929
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009930 all-retryable-errors
9931 retry request for any error that are considered
9932 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9933 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9934 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9935
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009936 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9937 not cumulative.
9938
9939 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9940 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9941 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9942 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9943
9944 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9945 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9946 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9947 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9948 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9949 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9950 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9951 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9952 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9953 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9954 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9955 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9956
9957 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9958 should not use this directive.
9959
9960 The default is "conn-failure".
9961
9962 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9963
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009964server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009965 Declare a server in a backend
9966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9967 no | no | yes | yes
9968 Arguments :
9969 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009970 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009971 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009972
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009973 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9974 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9975 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9976 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009977 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9978 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9979 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9980 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9981 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009982 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9983 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9984 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9985 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9986 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9987 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9988 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009989 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009990 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9991 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9992 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9993 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9994 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9995 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009996 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9997 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009998 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9999 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010001 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010002 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10003 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10004 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10005 adding this value to the client's port.
10006
10007 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10008 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010009 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010010
10011 Examples :
10012 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10013 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010014 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010015 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10016 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10017 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010018
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010019 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10020 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10021 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10022 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10023 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10024
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010025 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10026 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010027
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010028server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010029 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010030 this backend.
10031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 no | no | yes | yes
10033
10034 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10035 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10036 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10037 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10038 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010039
10040 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10041 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10042
10043 global
10044 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10045
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010046 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010047 load-server-state-from-file
10048
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010049 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010050 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010051
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010052server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10053 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10054 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10056 no | no | yes | yes
10057
10058 Arguments:
10059 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10060
10061 <num | range>
10062 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10063 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10064 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10065 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10066
10067 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10068
10069 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10070
10071 <params*>
10072 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10073 keyword.
10074
10075 Examples:
10076 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10077 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10078 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10079
10080 # or
10081 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10082
10083 # would be equivalent to:
10084 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10085 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10086 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10087
10088
10089
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010090source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010091source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010092source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010093 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10095 yes | no | yes | yes
10096 Arguments :
10097 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10098 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010099
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010100 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010101 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10102 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10103 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10104 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10105 supported prefixes are :
10106 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10107 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10108 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010109 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010110 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10111 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010112
10113 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10114 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010115 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10116 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10117 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010118
10119 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10120 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10121 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10122 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10123 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10124 <addr>.
10125
10126 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10127 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10128 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10129 port.
10130
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010131 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10132 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10133 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10134 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010135 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010136 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10137 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10138 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10139 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10140 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10141 HTTP header.
10142
10143 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10144 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010145 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010146 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10147 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10148 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10149 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10150 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10151 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10152 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10153
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010154 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10155 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10156 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10157 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10158 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10159 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10160
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010161 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10162 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10163 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10164 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10165
10166 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10167 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10168 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10169 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10170 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10171 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10172
10173 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10174 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10175 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10176 there are two methods :
10177
10178 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10179 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10180 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10181 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10182 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10183 of the client ranges may be used.
10184
10185 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10186 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10187 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10188 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10189 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10190 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10191 same session.
10192
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010193 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10194 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10195 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010196 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010197
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010198 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10199
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010200 Examples :
10201 backend private
10202 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10203 source 192.168.1.200
10204
10205 backend transparent_ssl1
10206 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10207 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10208
10209 backend transparent_ssl2
10210 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10211 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10212 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10213
10214 backend transparent_ssl3
10215 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10216 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10217 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10218
10219 backend transparent_smtp
10220 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10221 # with Tproxy version 4.
10222 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10223
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010224 backend transparent_http
10225 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10226 # proxy.
10227 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010229 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010230 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10231
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010232
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010233srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10234 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10235 the connection on the server side.
10236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10237 yes | no | yes | yes
10238 Arguments :
10239 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10240
10241 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10242 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010243 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10244 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010245
10246 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10247
10248
10249srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10250 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10251 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10252 server side.
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10254 yes | no | yes | yes
10255 Arguments :
10256 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10257 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10258 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10259 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10260
10261 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10262 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010263 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10264 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010265
10266 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10267
10268
10269srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10270 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10272 yes | no | yes | yes
10273 Arguments :
10274 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10275 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10276 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10277 document.
10278
10279 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10280 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010281 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10282 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010283
10284 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10285
10286
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010287stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10288 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010290 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010291
10292 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10293 matched.
10294
10295 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10296 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10297
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010298 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10299 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010300 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010301
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010302 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10303 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10304 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10305 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010306
10307 Example :
10308 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10309 backend stats_localhost
10310 stats enable
10311 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10312
10313 Example :
10314 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10315 backend stats_auth
10316 stats enable
10317 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10318 stats admin if TRUE
10319
10320 Example :
10321 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10322 userlist stats-auth
10323 group admin users admin
10324 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10325 group readonly users haproxy
10326 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10327
10328 backend stats_auth
10329 stats enable
10330 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10331 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10332 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10333 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010335 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10336 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10337 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010338
10339
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010340stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10341 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010343 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344 Arguments :
10345 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10346
10347 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10348
10349 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10350 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10351 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10352 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10353 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10354 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10355
10356 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10357 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10358 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010359 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010360
10361 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10362 report using "stats scope".
10363
10364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10366 unobvious parameters.
10367
10368 Example :
10369 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10370 backend public_www
10371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10372 stats enable
10373 stats hide-version
10374 stats scope .
10375 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010376 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10378 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10379
10380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10381 backend private_monitoring
10382 stats enable
10383 stats uri /admin?stats
10384 stats refresh 5s
10385
10386 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10387
10388
10389stats enable
10390 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010392 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010393 Arguments : none
10394
10395 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10396 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10397 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10398 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10399 - stats auth : no authentication
10400 - stats scope : no restriction
10401
10402 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10403 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10404 unobvious parameters.
10405
10406 Example :
10407 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10408 backend public_www
10409 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10410 stats enable
10411 stats hide-version
10412 stats scope .
10413 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010414 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10416 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10417
10418 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10419 backend private_monitoring
10420 stats enable
10421 stats uri /admin?stats
10422 stats refresh 5s
10423
10424 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10425
10426
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010427stats hide-version
10428 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010430 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010431 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010432
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010433 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10434 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10435 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10436 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10437 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10438 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010440 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10441 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10442 unobvious parameters.
10443
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010444 Example :
10445 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10446 backend public_www
10447 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010448 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010449 stats hide-version
10450 stats scope .
10451 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010452 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010453 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10454 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010455
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010456 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10457 backend private_monitoring
10458 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010459 stats uri /admin?stats
10460 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010461
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010462 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010463
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010464
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010465stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10466 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10467 Access control for statistics
10468
10469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 no | no | yes | yes
10471
10472 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10473 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10474 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10475 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10476 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10477 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10478
10479 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10480 instance.
10481
10482 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10483 about ACL usage.
10484
10485
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486stats realm <realm>
10487 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010489 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010490 Arguments :
10491 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10492 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10493 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10494
10495 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10496 using a backslash ('\').
10497
10498 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10499 only related to authentication.
10500
10501 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10502 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10503 unobvious parameters.
10504
10505 Example :
10506 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10507 backend public_www
10508 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10509 stats enable
10510 stats hide-version
10511 stats scope .
10512 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010514 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10515 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10516
10517 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10518 backend private_monitoring
10519 stats enable
10520 stats uri /admin?stats
10521 stats refresh 5s
10522
10523 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10524
10525
10526stats refresh <delay>
10527 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010529 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530 Arguments :
10531 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10532 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10533 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10534 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10535 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10536 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10537
10538 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10539 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10540 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010541 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010542
10543 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10544 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10545 unobvious parameters.
10546
10547 Example :
10548 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10549 backend public_www
10550 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10551 stats enable
10552 stats hide-version
10553 stats scope .
10554 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010555 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010556 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10557 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10558
10559 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10560 backend private_monitoring
10561 stats enable
10562 stats uri /admin?stats
10563 stats refresh 5s
10564
10565 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10566
10567
10568stats scope { <name> | "." }
10569 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010571 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010572 Arguments :
10573 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10574 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10575 section in which the statement appears.
10576
10577 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10578 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10579 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10580 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10581 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10582 exists.
10583
10584 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10585 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10586 unobvious parameters.
10587
10588 Example :
10589 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10590 backend public_www
10591 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10592 stats enable
10593 stats hide-version
10594 stats scope .
10595 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010596 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010597 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10598 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10599
10600 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10601 backend private_monitoring
10602 stats enable
10603 stats uri /admin?stats
10604 stats refresh 5s
10605
10606 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010608
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010609stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010610 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010612 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010614 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010615 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10616
10617 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10618 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10619
10620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010622 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010623
10624 Example :
10625 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10626 backend private_monitoring
10627 stats enable
10628 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10629 stats uri /admin?stats
10630 stats refresh 5s
10631
10632 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10633 global section.
10634
10635
10636stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010637 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10639 yes | yes | yes | yes
10640 Arguments : none
10641
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010642 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010643 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10644 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10645 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10646 - IP (socket, server)
10647 - cookie (backend, server)
10648
10649 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10650 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010652
10653 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10654
10655
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010656stats show-modules
10657 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10659 yes | yes | yes | yes
10660 Arguments : none
10661
10662 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10663 values as a tooltip.
10664
10665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10667 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10668
10669 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10670
10671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010672stats show-node [ <name> ]
10673 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010675 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010676 Arguments:
10677 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10678 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10679
10680 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10681 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010682 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010683
10684 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10685 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10686 unobvious parameters.
10687
10688 Example:
10689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10690 backend private_monitoring
10691 stats enable
10692 stats show-node Europe-1
10693 stats uri /admin?stats
10694 stats refresh 5s
10695
10696 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10697 section.
10698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010699
10700stats uri <prefix>
10701 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010704 Arguments :
10705 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10706 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10707 query string.
10708
10709 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10710 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10711 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10712 possible to reach it in the application.
10713
10714 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010715 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010716 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10717 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10718 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10719 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10720
10721 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10722 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10723 an address or a port to statistics only.
10724
10725 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10726 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10727 unobvious parameters.
10728
10729 Example :
10730 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10731 backend public_www
10732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10733 stats enable
10734 stats hide-version
10735 stats scope .
10736 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010737 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010738 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10739 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10740
10741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10742 backend private_monitoring
10743 stats enable
10744 stats uri /admin?stats
10745 stats refresh 5s
10746
10747 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10748
10749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010750stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10751 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010753 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010754
10755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010756 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010757 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010758 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010759 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10760
10761 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10762 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10763 the "stick-table" statement.
10764
10765 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10766 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10767 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10768 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10769 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10770
10771 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10772 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10773 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10774 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10775 transformation rules.
10776
10777 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10778 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10779 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10780 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10781 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10782 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10783 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10784
10785 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10786 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10787 ACL based conditions.
10788
10789 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10790 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10791 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10792 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10793
10794 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10795 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10796 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10797 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10798
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010799 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10800 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010801 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010802
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010803 Example :
10804 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10805 # last 30 minutes
10806 backend pop
10807 mode tcp
10808 balance roundrobin
10809 stick store-request src
10810 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10811 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10812 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10813
10814 backend smtp
10815 mode tcp
10816 balance roundrobin
10817 stick match src table pop
10818 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10819 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010821 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010822 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010823
10824
10825stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10826 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10828 no | no | yes | yes
10829
10830 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10831 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10832 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10833 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10834
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010835 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10836 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010837 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010838
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010839 Examples :
10840 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010841 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010842
10843 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10844 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10845 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10846
10847
10848 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10849 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10850 backend http
10851 mode http
10852 balance roundrobin
10853 stick on src table https
10854 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10855 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10856 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10857
10858 backend https
10859 mode tcp
10860 balance roundrobin
10861 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10862 stick on src
10863 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10864 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10865
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010866 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010867
10868
10869stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10870 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 no | no | yes | yes
10873
10874 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010875 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010876 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010877 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010878 server is selected.
10879
10880 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10881 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10882 the "stick-table" statement.
10883
10884 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10885 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10886 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10887 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10888 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10889 address.
10890
10891 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10892 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10893 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10894 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10895 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10896 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10897 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10898 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10899 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10900 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10901
10902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10909
10910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10913 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10914
10915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010921 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10922 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10923 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10924 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10925 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10926 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010927
10928 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10929 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10930 the request.
10931
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010932 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10933 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010935
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010936 Example :
10937 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10938 # last 30 minutes
10939 backend pop
10940 mode tcp
10941 balance roundrobin
10942 stick store-request src
10943 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10944 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10945 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10946
10947 backend smtp
10948 mode tcp
10949 balance roundrobin
10950 stick match src table pop
10951 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10952 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10953
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010954 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010955 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010956
10957
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010958stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010959 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010960 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010961 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010963 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010964
10965 Arguments :
10966 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10967 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10968 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10969 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10970
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010971 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10972 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10973 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10974 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10975
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010976 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10977 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10978 instance.
10979
10980 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10981 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10982 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10983 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10984 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10985 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010986 to 32 characters.
10987
10988 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10989 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10990 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010991 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010992 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10993 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010994
10995 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010996 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10997 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010998 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10999 increase.
11000
11001 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011002 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11003 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11004 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011005
11006 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11007 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11008 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11009 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011011 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11012 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11013 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11014 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11015 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11016 parameter (see below).
11017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011018 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11019 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11020 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11021 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11022 soft restart.
11023
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011024 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11025 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011026
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011027 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11028 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11029 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11030 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011031 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011032 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011033 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11034 if not expiration delay is specified.
11035
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011036 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11037 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11038 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11039 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11040 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11041 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11042 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11043 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11044 token.
11045
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011046 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11047 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11048 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11049 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011050 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11051 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11052 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11053 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11054 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11055 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11056 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11057 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11058 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11059 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11060 types and their arguments.
11061
11062 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11063 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11064 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11065 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11066
11067 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11068 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11069 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011071
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011072 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11073 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11074 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011075 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011076 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011077 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011078
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011079 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11080 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11081 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11082 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11083
11084 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11085 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11086 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11087 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11088 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11089 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11090
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011091 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11092 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11093 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11094 they were received.
11095
11096 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11097 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11098 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11099 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11100 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11101
11102 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11103 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11104 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11105 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11106 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11107
11108 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11109 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11110 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11111
11112 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11113 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11114 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11115 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11116 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11117
11118 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11119 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11120 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11121 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11122 the client side.
11123
11124 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11125 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11126 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11127 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11128 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11129 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11130 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11131
11132 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11133 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11134 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11135 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11136 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11137 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011138 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011139
11140 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11141 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11142 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11143 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11144 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11145 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11146
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011147 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11148 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11149 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11150 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11151 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11152
11153 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11154 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11155 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11156 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11157 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11158 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11159
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011160 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011162 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11163 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11164
11165 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11166 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11167 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11168 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11169 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11170 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11171 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11172 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11173 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11174 recommended for better fairness.
11175
11176 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011178 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11179 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11180
11181 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11182 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11183 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11184 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11185 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11186 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11187 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11188 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11189 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11190 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011191
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011192 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11193 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011194 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11195 reference it.
11196
11197 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11198 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011199 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11200 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11201 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011202
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011203 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11204 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11205 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11206 something that can be ignored.
11207
11208 Example:
11209 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11210 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11211 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11212 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11213
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011214 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011215 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011216
11217
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011218stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011219 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11221 no | no | yes | yes
11222
11223 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011224 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011225 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011226 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011227 server is selected.
11228
11229 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11230 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11231 the "stick-table" statement.
11232
11233 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11234 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11235 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11236 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11237
11238 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11239 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11240 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11241 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11242 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11243 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011244 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011245 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11246 rules.
11247
11248 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11249 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11250 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11251 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11252 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11253 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11254 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11255
11256 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11257 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11258 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11259 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11260
11261 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11262 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11263 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11264 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11265 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11266 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011267 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11268 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11269 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11270 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11271 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11272 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11273 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11274 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11275 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011276
11277 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11278
11279 Example :
11280 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11281 backend https
11282 mode tcp
11283 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011284 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011285 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011286
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011287 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11288 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11289
11290 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11291 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11292 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11293
11294 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11295 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011296
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011297 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11298 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11299 # at offset 44.
11300
11301 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11302 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11303
11304 # Learn on response if server hello.
11305 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011306
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011307 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11308 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11309
11310 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11311 extraction.
11312
11313
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011314tcp-check comment <string>
11315 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11316 it fails.
11317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11318 yes | no | yes | yes
11319
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011320 Arguments :
11321 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11322 rule fails.
11323
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011324 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11325 user-friendly error reporting.
11326
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011327 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11328 "tcp-check expect".
11329
11330
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011331tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11332 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011333 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011334 Opens a new connection
11335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011336 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011337
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011338 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011339 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11340
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011341 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011342 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011343
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011344 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011345 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11346 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011347 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011348
11349 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011350
11351 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11352
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011353 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11354
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011355 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11356
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011357 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11358
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011359 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11360 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11361 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11362 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11363
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011364 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11365 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11366 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11367 haproxy -vv.
11368
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011369 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011370
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011371 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11372 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11373 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11374
11375 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11376 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11377 of the sequence.
11378
11379 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11380 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11381 do.
11382
11383 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11384 unset-var or comment rules.
11385
11386 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011387 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11388 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11389 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11390 option tcp-check
11391 tcp-check connect
11392 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11393 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11394 tcp-check send \r\n
11395 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11396 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11397 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11398 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11399 tcp-check send \r\n
11400 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11401 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11402
11403 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11404 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011405 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011406 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11407 tcp-check connect port 143
11408 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11409 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11410
11411 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11412
11413
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011414tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011415 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011416 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011417 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011418 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011421
11422 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011423 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11424
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011425 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11426 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11427 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11428 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11429 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11430 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11431 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11432 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11433 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11434 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11435
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011436 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011437 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11438 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011439 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11440 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11441 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11442
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011443 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11444 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11445 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011446 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11447 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011448 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11449 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011450 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11451 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011452 By default "L7OK" is used.
11453
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011454 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11455 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011456 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11457 supported :
11458 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11459 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011460 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11461 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11462 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11463 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11464 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011465
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011466 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011467 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011468 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11469 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11470 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11471 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011472 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11473
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011474 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11475 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11476 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11477 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11478
11479 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11480 informational message reported in logs if an error
11481 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11482 log-format string.
11483
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011484 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11485 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11486 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11487 followed by some converters.
11488
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011489 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11490 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11491 with the usual backslash ('\').
11492 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011494 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11495 used upper or lower case.
11496
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011497 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11498
11499 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11500 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11501 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11502 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11503 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11504 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11505 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11506 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11507
11508 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11509 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11510 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11511 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11512 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11513 expression.
11514
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011515 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11516 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11517 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11518 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11519 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11520 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11521
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011522 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11523 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11524 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11525 this exact hexadecimal string.
11526 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11527
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011528 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11529 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11530 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11531 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11532 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11533 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11534 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11535 size.
11536
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011537 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11538 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11539 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11540 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11541 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11542 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11543 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11544 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11545 in a binary string before matching the response's
11546 buffer.
11547
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011548 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011549 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011550 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11551 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11552 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11553 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11554 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11555 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11556 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11557 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11558 the null character.
11559
11560 Examples :
11561 # perform a POP check
11562 option tcp-check
11563 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11564
11565 # perform an IMAP check
11566 option tcp-check
11567 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11568
11569 # look for the redis master server
11570 option tcp-check
11571 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011572 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011573 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11574 tcp-check expect string role:master
11575 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11576 tcp-check expect string +OK
11577
11578
11579 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011580 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011581
11582
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011583tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11584tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11585 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11586 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011588 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011589
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011590 Arguments :
11591 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11592
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011593 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11594 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011595
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011596 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11597 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011598
11599 Examples :
11600 # look for the redis master server
11601 option tcp-check
11602 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11603 tcp-check expect string role:master
11604
11605 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011606 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011607
11608
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011609tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11610tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11611 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11612 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011614 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011615
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011616 Arguments :
11617 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011618
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011619 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11620 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011621
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011622 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11623 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11624 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011625
11626 Examples :
11627 # redis check in binary
11628 option tcp-check
11629 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11630 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11631
11632
11633 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011634 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011635
11636
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011637tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011638 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011640 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011641
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011642 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011643 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11644 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11645 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11646 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11647 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11648 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11649 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11650 and '-'.
11651
11652 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011654 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011655 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11656
11657
11658tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011659 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011661 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011663 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011664 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11665 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11666 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11667 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11668 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11670 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11671 and '-'.
11672
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011673 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011674 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11675
11676
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011677tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11678 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11680 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011681 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011682 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11683 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011685 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011686
11687 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11688 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011689 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11690 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11691 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11692 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11693 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11694 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011695
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011696 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11697 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11698 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11699 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011700
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011701 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011702 - accept :
11703 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11704 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11705 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011707 - reject :
11708 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11709 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11710 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11711 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11712 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11713 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11714 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11715 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11716 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11717 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11718 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011719 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011720
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011721 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11722 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11723 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11724 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11725 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11726 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11727 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11728 hosts.
11729
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011730 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11731 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11732 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11733 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11734 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11735 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11736 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11737 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11738
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011739 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11740 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11741 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11742 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11743 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11744 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11745 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11746 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11747 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011748 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11749 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011750
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011751 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011752 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011753 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11754 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11755 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011756 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011757 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011758 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11759 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11760 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11761 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11762 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11763 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11764 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011766 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011767 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011768 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011769 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011770 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11771 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11772 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011773
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011774 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11775 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11776 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11777 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011779 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11780 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11781 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11782 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11783 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011784 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11785 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11786 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11787 layer7 information is extracted.
11788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011789 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11790 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11791 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11792 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11793 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011794
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011795 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11796 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11797 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11798 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11799
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011800 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11801 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11802 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11803 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11804
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011805 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11806 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11807 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11808 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11809 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011810
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011811 - set-src <expr> :
11812 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11813 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11814 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011815 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011817 Arguments:
11818 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11819 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011820
11821 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011822 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11823
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011824 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11825 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011826
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011827 - set-src-port <expr> :
11828 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11829 expression.
11830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011831 Arguments:
11832 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11833 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011834
11835 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011836 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11837
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011838 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11839 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11840 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011841
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011842 - set-dst <expr> :
11843 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11844 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11845 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11846 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11847 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11848
11849 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11850 followed by some converters.
11851
11852 Example:
11853
11854 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11855 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11856
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011857 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11858 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11859
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011860 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11861 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11862 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11863 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11864
11865
11866 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11867 followed by some converters.
11868
11869 Example:
11870
11871 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11872
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011873 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11874 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11875 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11876
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011877 - "silent-drop" :
11878 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011879 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011880 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11881 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11882 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11883 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11884 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011885 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11886 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011887 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11888 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011889 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011890 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11891 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11892 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11893 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011895 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11896 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11897 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011899 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11900 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11901 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011903 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011904 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011905 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011906
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011907 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11908 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11909 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011911 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011912 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11913 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011914
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011915 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11916
11917 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11918
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011919 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11920
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011921 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011922
11923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011924tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11925 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011927 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011929 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11930 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011932 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011933
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011934 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011935 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11936 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011937 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11938 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011940 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11941 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11942 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11943 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011944 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11945 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11946 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11947 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11948 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11949 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011950 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011951 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011953 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11954 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11955 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11956 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011957
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011958 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011959 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011960 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011961 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11962 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011963 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011964 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011965 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011966 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011967 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011968 - set-dst <expr>
11969 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011970 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011971 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011972 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011973 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011974 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011975 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011977 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11978 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011979 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11980 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011981
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011982 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11983 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11984 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11985 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11986 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11987 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011989 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011990 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11991 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011992
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011993 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11994 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11995 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11996 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11997 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11998 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012000 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012001 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12002 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12003 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12004 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12005 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12006 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12007 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12008 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12009 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12010 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012011
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012012 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012013 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12014 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12015 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012016
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012017 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12018 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12019
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012020 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012021 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12022 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012023
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012024 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12025 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012026 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012027 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12028 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012029 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012030 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012031 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012032 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12033 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012034 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012035 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12036 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012037
12038 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12039 followed by some converters.
12040
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012041 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12042 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12043 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12044 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12045 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12046 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12047 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
12048 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
12049 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12050 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12051
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012052 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12053
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012054 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12055 <var-name>.
12056
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012057 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12058 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12059 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12060 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12061 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12062
12063 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12064 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12065 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12066 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12067 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12068 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12069 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12070 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12071 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12072 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12073 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12074
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012075 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12076 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12077 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12078 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12079 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12080
12081 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12082
12083 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12084
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012085 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12086 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12087 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12088 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12089 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12090 evaluated.
12091
12092 Example:
12093 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12094
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012095 Example:
12096
12097 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012098 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012099
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012100 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012101 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012102 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012103 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12104 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012105 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012106 tcp-request content reject
12107
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012108 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12109 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12110 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12111 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12112 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12113 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12114 ...
12115 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012117 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012118 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12119 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12120 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012121 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012122
12123 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12124 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12125 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012126 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012127 tcp-request content reject
12128
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012129 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012130 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012131 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012132 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012133 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12134 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012135
12136 Example:
12137 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12138 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012139 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012141 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012142 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012143
12144 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146 # protecting all our sites
12147 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012148 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12149 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012150 ...
12151 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12152
12153 backend http_dynamic
12154 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012155 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012156 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012157 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012158 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012159 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012160 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012162 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012163
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012164 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12165 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012166
12167
12168tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12169 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012171 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172 Arguments :
12173 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12174 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12175 as explained at the top of this document.
12176
12177 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12178 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12179 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12180 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12181 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12182
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012183 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12184 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12185 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12186 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12187
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012188 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12189 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012190 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012191 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012192 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12193 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12194 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12195 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012196
12197 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12198 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12199 it pass through unaffected.
12200
12201 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12202 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12203 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012204 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012205 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12206 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012207 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12208 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12209 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012210
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012211 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012212 "timeout client".
12213
12214
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012215tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12216 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12218 no | no | yes | yes
12219 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012220 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12221 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012222
12223 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012225 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012226 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12227 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012228 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12229 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012230
12231 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12232
12233 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12234 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12235 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12236 inserted.
12237
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012238 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012239 - accept :
12240 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12241 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12242 the rules evaluation.
12243
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012244 - close :
12245 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12246 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12247 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12248 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12249 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12250 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012251 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012252 protocols.
12253
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012254 - reject :
12255 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12256 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012257 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012258
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012259 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12260 Sets a variable.
12261
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012262 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12263 Unsets a variable.
12264
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012265 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12266 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12267 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12268 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12269
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012270 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12271 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12272 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12273 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12274
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012275 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12276 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12277 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12278 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12279 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012280
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012281 - "silent-drop" :
12282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012283 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012284 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12285 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12286 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12287 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12288 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012289 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12290 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012291 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12292 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012293 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012294 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12295 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12296 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12297 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12298
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012299 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12300 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12301
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012302 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12303 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12304 for changing the default action to a reject.
12305
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012306 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12307 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12308 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12309 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012310 period.
12311
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012312 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12313 declared inline.
12314
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012315 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12316 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12319 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012320 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012321 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012322 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012323 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12324 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012325 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012326 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12327 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012328
12329 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12330 followed by some converters.
12331
12332 Example:
12333
12334 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12335
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012336 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12337 <var-name>.
12338
12339 Example:
12340
12341 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12342
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012343 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12344 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12345 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12346 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12347 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12348
12349 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12350
12351 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12352
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012353 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12354
12355 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12356
12357
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012358tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12359 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12361 no | yes | yes | no
12362 Arguments :
12363 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12364 below.
12365
12366 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012368 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012369 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12370 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12371 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12372 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12373 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12374 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12375 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012376 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012377 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12378 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12379 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12380 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12381 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12382 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12383 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12384 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12385 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12386 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12387 instead.
12388
12389 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12390 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12391 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12392 rules which may be inserted.
12393
12394 Several types of actions are supported :
12395 - accept : the request is accepted
12396 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12397 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12398 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012399 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012400 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012401 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012402 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012403 - silent-drop
12404
12405 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12406 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12407 sections for a complete description.
12408
12409 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12410 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12411 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12412
12413 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12414 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12415 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12416 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12417 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12418
12419 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12420 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12421
12422 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12423 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12424 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12425
12426 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12427 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12428 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12429
12430 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12431 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12432 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12433
12434 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12435 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12436 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12437
12438 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12439
12440 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12441
12442
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012443tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12444 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12446 no | no | yes | yes
12447 Arguments :
12448 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12449 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12450 as explained at the top of this document.
12451
12452 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12453
12454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012455timeout check <timeout>
12456 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12457 established.
12458
12459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12460 yes | no | yes | yes
12461 Arguments:
12462 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12463 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12464 as explained at the top of this document.
12465
12466 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12467 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012469 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012470 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12471 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12472 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012473
12474 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12475 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12476
12477 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12478 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012479 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012480
12481 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12482 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12483 forget about it.
12484
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012485 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12486 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012487
12488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012489timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012490 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12492 yes | yes | yes | no
12493 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012494 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012495 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12496 as explained at the top of this document.
12497
12498 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12499 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12500 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012501 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12502 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12503 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12504 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012505 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12506 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12507 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012508 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012509 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012510 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12511 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012512 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12513 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012514
12515 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12516 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12517 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12518 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012519 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012520 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12521
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012522 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012523
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012524 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012526
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012527timeout client-fin <timeout>
12528 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12530 yes | yes | yes | no
12531 Arguments :
12532 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12533 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12534 as explained at the top of this document.
12535
12536 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12537 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12538 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12539 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12540 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12541 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12542 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012543 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12544 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12545 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012546
12547 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12548 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12549 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12550
12551 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12552
12553
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012554timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012555 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12557 yes | no | yes | yes
12558 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012559 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012560 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12561 as explained at the top of this document.
12562
12563 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012564 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012565 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012566 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012567 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12568 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012569
12570 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12571 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12572 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12573 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012574 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012575 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12576
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012577 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012579
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012580timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12581 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12583 yes | yes | yes | yes
12584 Arguments :
12585 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12586 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12587 as explained at the top of this document.
12588
12589 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12590 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12591 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12592 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12593 once the request has started to present itself.
12594
12595 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12596 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12597 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12598 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12599 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12600
12601 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12602 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12603 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12604 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12605
12606 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12607 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012608 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012609 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12610 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012611 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012612
12613 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12614 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12615 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12616 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12617
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012618 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12619 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012620 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12621
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012622 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12623
12624
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012625timeout http-request <timeout>
12626 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012628 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012629 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012630 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12632 as explained at the top of this document.
12633
12634 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12635 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12636 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12637 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12638 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12639 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12640 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012641 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12642 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12643 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12644 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012646 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12647 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012648
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012649 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12650 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12651 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12652 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12653 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012654 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012655
12656 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12657 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012658 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012659 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12660 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12661
12662 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012663 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12664 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12665 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012666
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012667 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012668 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012669
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012670
12671timeout queue <timeout>
12672 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12674 yes | no | yes | yes
12675 Arguments :
12676 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12677 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12678 as explained at the top of this document.
12679
12680 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12681 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12682 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12683 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12684 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12685
12686 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12687 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12688 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12689 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12690
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012691 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012692
12693
12694timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012695 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12697 yes | no | yes | yes
12698 Arguments :
12699 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12700 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12701 as explained at the top of this document.
12702
12703 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12704 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12705 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12706 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12707 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12708 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12709 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12710
12711 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12712 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12713 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12714 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12715 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012716 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012717 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012718 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12719 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012720 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12721 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012722
12723 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12724 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12725 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12726 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012727 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012728 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12729
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012730 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012731
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012732
12733timeout server-fin <timeout>
12734 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12736 yes | no | yes | yes
12737 Arguments :
12738 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12739 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12740 as explained at the top of this document.
12741
12742 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12743 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12744 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12745 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12746 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12747 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12748 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12749 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12750 situations, it should not be needed.
12751
12752 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12753 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12754 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12755
12756 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12757
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012758
12759timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012760 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12762 yes | yes | yes | yes
12763 Arguments :
12764 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12766 as explained at the top of this document.
12767
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012768 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12769 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12770 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012771
12772 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12773 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12774 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12775 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012776 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012777
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012778 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012779
12780
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012781timeout tunnel <timeout>
12782 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12784 yes | no | yes | yes
12785 Arguments :
12786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12788 as explained at the top of this document.
12789
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012790 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012791 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12792 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12793 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012794 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12795 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012796 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12797 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12798 specified.
12799
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012800 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12801 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12802 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12803 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12804 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12805 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12806 state.
12807
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012808 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12809 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12810 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12811 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012812 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012813
12814 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12816 forget about it.
12817
12818 Example :
12819 defaults http
12820 option http-server-close
12821 timeout connect 5s
12822 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012823 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012824 timeout server 30s
12825 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12826
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012827 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012828
12829
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012830transparent (deprecated)
12831 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012833 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834 Arguments : none
12835
12836 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12837 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12838 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12839 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12840 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12841 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12842 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12843 appropriate server.
12844
12845 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12846
12847 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12848 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12849
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012850 See also: "option transparent"
12851
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012852unique-id-format <string>
12853 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12855 yes | yes | yes | no
12856 Arguments :
12857 <string> is a log-format string.
12858
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012859 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12860 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12861 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12862 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012863
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012864 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12865 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12866 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12867 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12868 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12869 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12870 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12871 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012872
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012873 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12874 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012875
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012876 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012877
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012878 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012879
12880 will generate:
12881
12882 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12883
12884 See also: "unique-id-header"
12885
12886unique-id-header <name>
12887 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12889 yes | yes | yes | no
12890 Arguments :
12891 <name> is the name of the header.
12892
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012893 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12894 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012895
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012896 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012897
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012898 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012899 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12900
12901 will generate:
12902
12903 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12904
12905 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012906
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012907use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012908 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12910 no | yes | yes | no
12911 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012912 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12913 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012914
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012915 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12916 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012917
12918 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12919 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12920 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012921 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012922 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012923 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12924 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012925
12926 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12927 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12928 assign the backend.
12929
12930 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12931 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12932 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12933 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12934 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12935 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12936
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012937 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012938 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012939 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12940 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12941 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12942
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012943 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12944 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12945 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12946 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12947 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12948 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12949 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12950 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12951 cannot be forced from the request.
12952
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012953 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012954 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12955 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12956
12957 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12958 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012959
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012960use-fcgi-app <name>
12961 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12963 no | no | yes | yes
12964 Arguments :
12965 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12966
12967 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012968
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012969use-server <server> if <condition>
12970use-server <server> unless <condition>
12971 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12973 no | no | yes | yes
12974 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012975 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12976 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012977
12978 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12979
12980 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12981 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12982 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12983
12984 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12985 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12986 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12987 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12988 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12989 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12990 matches will assign the server.
12991
12992 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12993 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12994 with the next rules until one matches.
12995
12996 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12997 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12998 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12999 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13000
13001 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13002 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13003 stripped.
13004
13005 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13006 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013007 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13008 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13009 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013010
13011 Example :
13012 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13013 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13014 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13015 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013016 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013017 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013018 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013019 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13020 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13021
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013022 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13023 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13024 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13025 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013026 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013027 and we fall back to load balancing.
13028
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013029 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130325. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013033--------------------------
13034
13035The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13036depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13037settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13038written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13039described in this section.
13040
13041
130425.1. Bind options
13043-----------------
13044
13045The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13046as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13047no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13048parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13049while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13050provided immediately after the setting name.
13051
13052The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13053
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013054accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13055 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13056 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13057 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13058 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13059 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13060 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13061 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13062 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13063 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013064 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13065 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13066 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013068accept-proxy
13069 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013070 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13071 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013072 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13073 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13074 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13075 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013077 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13078 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013079 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13080 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013081
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013082allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013083 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013084 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013085 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013086 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13087 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013088
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013089alpn <protocols>
13090 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13091 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13092 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013093 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013094 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013095 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13096 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13097 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13098 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13099 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13100 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13101 preference, like below :
13102
13103 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013104
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013105backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013106 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013107 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13108
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013109curves <curves>
13110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13111 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13112 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13113 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13114 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13115 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13116
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013117ecdhe <named curve>
13118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013119 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13120 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013121
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013122ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13124 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13125 client's certificate.
13126
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013127ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13129 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13130 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13131 error is ignored.
13132
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013133ca-sign-file <cafile>
13134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13135 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13136 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13137 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13138 'generate-certificates' for details.
13139
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013140ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13142 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13143 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13144 'generate-certificates' for details.
13145
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013146ca-verify-file <cafile>
13147 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13148 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13149 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13150 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13151 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013153ciphers <ciphers>
13154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13155 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013156 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013157 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013158 information and recommendations see e.g.
13159 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13160 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13161 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13162
13163ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13165 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13166 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13167 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013168 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13169 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013170
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013171crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13173 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13174 to verify client's certificate.
13175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013176crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13178 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13179 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13180 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13181 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013182 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13183 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013184
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013185 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13186 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13187
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013188 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13189 are loaded.
13190
13191 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013192 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13193 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13194 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13195 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13196 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13197 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13198 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013199 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013200
13201 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13202 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13203 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13204 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013205 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13206 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013207
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013208 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013209
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013210 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013211 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013212 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13213 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013214 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13215 clients).
13216
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013217 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13218 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13219 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13220 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13221 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13222 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13223 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13224 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13225 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13226 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13227 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13228 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13229 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13230
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013231 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13232 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13233 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13234 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13235 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13236
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013237 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13238 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13239 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13240 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013241
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013242 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13243 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13244 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013245
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013246crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013248 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013249 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013250 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013251
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013252crt-list <file>
13253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013254 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13255 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013256
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013257 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13258
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013259 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13260 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13261 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13262 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13263 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013264
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013265 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013266 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13267 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13268 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13269 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13270 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013271 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13272 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13273 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013274
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013275 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13276 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13277 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013278
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013279 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13280
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013281 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13282 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13283 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13284 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13285 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13286 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13287 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13288 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013289
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013290 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013291 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013292 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013293 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013294 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013295 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013297defer-accept
13298 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13299 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13300 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013301 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013302 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13303 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13304 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13305 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13306 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13307 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13308 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13309
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013310expose-fd listeners
13311 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13312 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013313 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13314 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013315 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013316
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013317force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013318 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013319 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013320 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013321 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013322
13323force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013324 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013325 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013326 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013327
13328force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013329 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013330 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013331 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013332
13333force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013334 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013335 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013336 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013337
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013338force-tlsv13
13339 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13340 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013341 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013342
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013343generate-certificates
13344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13345 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13346 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13347 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13348 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13349 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13350 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13351 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13352 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13353 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13354 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13355
13356 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13357 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013358 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013359 certificate is used many times.
13360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013361gid <gid>
13362 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13363 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13364 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13365 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13366 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13367
13368group <group>
13369 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13370 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13371 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13372 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13373 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13374
13375id <id>
13376 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13377 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13378 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13379 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13380
13381interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013382 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13383 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13384 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13385 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13386 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13387 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013388 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13389 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13390 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13391 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13392 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13393 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013394
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013395level <level>
13396 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13397 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13398 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013399 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013400 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13401 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13402 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013404 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013406 all counters).
13407
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013408severity-output <format>
13409 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13410 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13411 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13412 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13413 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13414 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13415 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13416 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13417 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13418 rfc5424 convention.
13419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420maxconn <maxconn>
13421 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13422 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13423 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13424 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13425 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13426 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13427 eat all memory.
13428
13429mode <mode>
13430 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13431 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13432 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13433 UNIX sockets.
13434
13435mss <maxseg>
13436 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13437 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13438 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13439 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13440 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13441 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13442 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13443 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13444 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13445 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13446 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13447
13448name <name>
13449 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13450 page.
13451
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013452namespace <name>
13453 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13454 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13455 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13456 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013458nice <nice>
13459 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13460 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13461 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13462 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13463 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13464 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13465 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13466 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13467 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13468 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13469 one for an RDP socket.
13470
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013471no-ca-names
13472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13473 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013474 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013475
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013476no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013478 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013479 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013480 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013481 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13482 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013483
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013484no-tls-tickets
13485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13486 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13487 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013488 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13489 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013490 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13491 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13492 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013493
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013494no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013496 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013497 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013498 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013499 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13500 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013501
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013502no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013504 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013505 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013506 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013507 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13508 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013509
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013510no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013512 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013513 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013514 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013515 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13516 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013517
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013518no-tlsv13
13519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13520 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13521 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13522 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013523 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13524 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013525
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013526npn <protocols>
13527 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13528 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13529 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013530 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013531 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013532 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13533 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13534 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13535 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13536 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013537
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013538prefer-client-ciphers
13539 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13540 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13541 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013542 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13543 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13544 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013545
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013546process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013547 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013548 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013549 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013550 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13551 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13552 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13553 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013554 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013555 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13556 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13557 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13558 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13559 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013560
13561 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13562
13563 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13564 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13565 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13566 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13567 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13568 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13569 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13570 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013571
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013572proto <name>
13573 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13574 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13575 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013576 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13577 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13578
13579 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13580 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13581 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13582 also reported (flag=HTX).
13583
13584 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13585 a bind line :
13586
13587 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13588 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13589 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13590
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013591 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013592 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013593 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013594 h2" on the bind line.
13595
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013596ssl
13597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013598 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013599 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13600 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013601 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13602 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013603
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013604ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13605 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013606 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13607 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13608 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013609 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13610
13611ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013612 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13613 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13614 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13615 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013616
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013617strict-sni
13618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13619 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13620 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13621 See the "crt" option for more information.
13622
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013623tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013624 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013625 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13626 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013627 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013628 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13629 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13630 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13631 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13632 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13633 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13634 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13635
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013636tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013637 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013638 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13639 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13640 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13641 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13642 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13643 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13644 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013645 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13646 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13647 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013648
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013649tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13650 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013651 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13652 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13653 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13654 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13655 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13656 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13657 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13658 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13659 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13660 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013661 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13662 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013664transparent
13665 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13666 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13667 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13668 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13669 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13670 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13671 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13672 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13673 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13674 so check for support with your vendor.
13675
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013676v4v6
13677 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13678 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13679 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13680 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013681 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013682
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013683v6only
13684 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13685 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13686 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013687 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13688 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013689
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013690uid <uid>
13691 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13692 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13693 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13694 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13695 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13696
13697user <user>
13698 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13699 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13700 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13701 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13702 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13703
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013704verify [none|optional|required]
13705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13706 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13707 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13708 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13709 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013710 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13711 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13712 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13713 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200137155.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013716------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013718The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13719which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13720arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13721settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13722after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13723Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13724address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013726 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013727 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013728
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013729Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13730keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013732The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013733
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013734addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013735 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013736 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13737 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13738 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13739 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13740 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013741
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013742agent-check
13743 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013744 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013745 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13746 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13747 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013748
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013749 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013750 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013751 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13752 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13753 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013755 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13756 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13757 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13758 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13759 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013760
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013761 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013763
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013764 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13765 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13766 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013767
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013768 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13769 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13770 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013771
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013772 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013773 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13774 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13775 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13776 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013778 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013779
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013780 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13781 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013782
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013783 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13784 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13785 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13786 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13787 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13788 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13789 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13790 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13791 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013792
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013793 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13794 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013795 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13796 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13797 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013798 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013799
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013800 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013801 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013802
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013803agent-send <string>
13804 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13805 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13806 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13807 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13808 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13809
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013810agent-inter <delay>
13811 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13812 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13813
13814 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13815 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13816 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13817 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13818 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13819 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13820 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13821 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13822 of backends use the same servers.
13823
13824 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13825
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013826agent-addr <addr>
13827 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13828
13829 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13830 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13831 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13832 hostname, it will be resolved.
13833
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013834agent-port <port>
13835 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13836
13837 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13838
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013839allow-0rtt
13840 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013841 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13842 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013843
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013844alpn <protocols>
13845 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13846 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13847 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013848 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013849 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13850 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13851 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13852 now obsolete NPN extension.
13853 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13854 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13855
13856 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013858backup
13859 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13860 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13861 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13862 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013863 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13864 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013865
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013866ca-file <cafile>
13867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13868 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13869 server's certificate.
13870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013871check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013872 This option enables health checks on a server:
13873 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13874 considered available.
13875 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13876 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13877 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13878 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13879 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13880 set.
13881 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13882 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13883 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13884 exchanges succeed.
13885
13886 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13887 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13888 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13889 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13890 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013891 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013892 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13893
13894 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13895 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13896
13897 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13898 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13899
13900 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13901 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13902 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13903 available.
13904
13905 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13906 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13907 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13908
13909 Example:
13910 # simple tcp check
13911 backend foo
13912 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13913 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13914 backend foo
13915 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13916 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13917 backend foo
13918 option tcp-check
13919 tcp-check connect
13920 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013921
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013922check-send-proxy
13923 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13924 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13925 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13926 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13927 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13928 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13929 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13930
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013931check-alpn <protocols>
13932 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13933 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13934 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13935
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013936check-proto <name>
13937 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13938 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13939 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013940 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13941 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13942
13943 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13944 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13945 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13946 also reported (flag=HTX).
13947
13948 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
13949 directive on a server line:
13950
13951 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13952 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13953 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13954 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13955
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013956 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013957 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13958 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13959
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013960check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013961 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013962 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13963 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013964
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013965check-ssl
13966 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13967 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13968 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13969 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013970 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013971 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13972 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013973 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013974 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13975 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013976
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013977check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013978 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013979 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13980 for normal traffic.
13981
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013982ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13984 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13985 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013986 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13987 information and recommendations see e.g.
13988 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13989 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13990 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013991
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013992ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13994 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13995 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13996 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013997 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13998 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13999 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014001cookie <value>
14002 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14003 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14004 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14005 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14006 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14007 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14008 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14009
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014010crl-file <crlfile>
14011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14012 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14013 to verify server's certificate.
14014
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014015crt <cert>
14016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14017 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14018 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14019 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14020 certificate request.
14021
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014022disabled
14023 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14024 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14025 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14026 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14027 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014028 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014029
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014030enabled
14031 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14032 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14033 default value.
14034 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14035 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014037error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014038 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14039 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14040 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014042 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014044fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014045 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14046 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14047 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14048
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014049force-sslv3
14050 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14051 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014052 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014053 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014054
14055force-tlsv10
14056 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014057 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014058 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014059
14060force-tlsv11
14061 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014062 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014063 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014064
14065force-tlsv12
14066 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014067 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014068 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014069
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014070force-tlsv13
14071 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14072 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014073 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014075id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014076 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14077 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14078 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014079
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014080init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14081 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14082 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014083 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014084 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14085 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14086 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14087 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14088 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14089 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14090 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14091 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14092 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014094 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14095 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14096 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14097 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14098 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14099 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014101
14102 Example:
14103 defaults
14104 # never fail on address resolution
14105 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014107inter <delay>
14108fastinter <delay>
14109downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14111 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14112 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14113 between checks depending on the server state :
14114
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014115 Server state | Interval used
14116 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14117 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14118 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14119 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14120 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14121 or yet unchecked. |
14122 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14123 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14124 | "inter" otherwise.
14125 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014127 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14128 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14129 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14130 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014131 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14132 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14133 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14134 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14135 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014136
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014137log-proto <logproto>
14138 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14139 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14140 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14141 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014143maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014144 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14145 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014146 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14147 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014148 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14149 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14150 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14151 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14152
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014153 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14154 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14155 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14156 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14157 than 50 concurrent requests.
14158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014159maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014160 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14161 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14162 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14163 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014164 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14165 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14166 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14167 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14168 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14169 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14170 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014171
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014172max-reuse <count>
14173 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14174 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14175 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14176 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14177 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14178 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14179 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14180 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014182minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14184 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14185 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14186 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14187 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14188 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014189 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014190 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014191
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014192namespace <name>
14193 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14194 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14195 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14196 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14197
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014198no-agent-check
14199 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14200 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14201 default value.
14202 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14203 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14204
14205no-backup
14206 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14207 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14208 default value.
14209 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14210 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14211
14212no-check
14213 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14214 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14215 default value.
14216 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14217 "default-server" "check" setting.
14218
14219no-check-ssl
14220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14222 default value.
14223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14224 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14225
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014226no-send-proxy
14227 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14228 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14229 default value.
14230 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14231 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14232
14233no-send-proxy-v2
14234 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14235 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14236 default value.
14237 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14238 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14239
14240no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14241 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14242 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14243 default value.
14244 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14245 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14246
14247no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14248 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14249 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14250 default value.
14251 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14252 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14253
14254no-ssl
14255 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14256 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14257 default value.
14258 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14259 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14260
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014261 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14262 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14263 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14264
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014265no-ssl-reuse
14266 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14267 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14268 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14269 and for paranoid users.
14270
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014271no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014272 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14273 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014274 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014275
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014276 Supported in default-server: No
14277
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014278no-tls-tickets
14279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14280 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14281 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014282 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14283 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014284 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14285 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14286 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014287 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014288
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014289no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014290 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014291 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14292 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014293 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14294 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014295 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014296
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014297 Supported in default-server: No
14298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014299no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014300 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014301 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14302 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014303 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14304 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014305 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014306
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014307 Supported in default-server: No
14308
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014309no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014310 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014311 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14312 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014313 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14314 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014315 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014316
14317 Supported in default-server: No
14318
14319no-tlsv13
14320 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14321 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14322 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14323 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14324 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014325 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014326
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014327 Supported in default-server: No
14328
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014329no-verifyhost
14330 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14331 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14332 default value.
14333 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14334 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014335
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014336no-tfo
14337 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14338 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14339 default value.
14340 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14341 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14342
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014343non-stick
14344 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14345 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14346 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14347
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014348npn <protocols>
14349 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14350 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14351 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014352 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014353 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14354 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14355 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014357observe <mode>
14358 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14359 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14360 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14361 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14362 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14363 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014364 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014365
14366 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014368on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014369 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14370 Currently, four modes are available:
14371 - fastinter: force fastinter
14372 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14373 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14374 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14375 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14376
14377 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14378
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014379on-marked-down <action>
14380 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14381 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014382 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14383 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14384 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14385 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14386 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14387 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14388 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14389 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014390
14391 Actions are disabled by default
14392
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014393on-marked-up <action>
14394 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14395 Currently one action is available:
14396 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14397 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14398 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14399 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014400 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14401 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014402 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14403 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14404
14405 Actions are disabled by default
14406
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014407pool-low-conn <max>
14408 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14409 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14410 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14411 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14412 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14413 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14414 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14415 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14416 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14417 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014418 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14419 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14420 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14421 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014422
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014423pool-max-conn <max>
14424 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14425 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14426 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14427 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14428 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14429 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14430
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014431pool-purge-delay <delay>
14432 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014433 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014434 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014436port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014437 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014438 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14439 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14440 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14441 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14442 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014443
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014444proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014445 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14446 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14447 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014448 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14449 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14450
14451 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14452 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14453 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14454 also reported (flag=HTX).
14455
14456 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14457 a server line :
14458
14459 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14460 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14461 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14462 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14463
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014464 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014465 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014467redir <prefix>
14468 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14469 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14470 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14471 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14472 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14473 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14474 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14475 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014476 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014478 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14479 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14480 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14481 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14482
14483 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014485rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014486 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14487 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14488 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14489
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014490resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14491 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14492 server.
14493
14494 Available options:
14495
14496 * allow-dup-ip
14497 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14498 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14499 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14500 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14501 For such case, simply enable this option.
14502 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14503
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014504 * ignore-weight
14505 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14506 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14507 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14508
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014509 * prevent-dup-ip
14510 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14511 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14512 same fqdn.
14513 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14514
14515 Example:
14516 backend b_myapp
14517 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14518 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14519 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14520
14521 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14522 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14523 it
14524 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14525 different address
14526
14527 Default value: not set
14528
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014529resolve-prefer <family>
14530 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14531 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14532 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14533 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14534
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014535 Default value: ipv6
14536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014537 Example:
14538
14539 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014540
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014541resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014542 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014543 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014544 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014545 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14546 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014547 configured network, another address is selected.
14548
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014549 Example:
14550
14551 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014552
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014553resolvers <id>
14554 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14555 hostname.
14556
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014557 Example:
14558
14559 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014560
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014561 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014562
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014563send-proxy
14564 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14565 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14566 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14567 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014568 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14569 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14570 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14571 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14572 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14573 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14574 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14575 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14576 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14577 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014578 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14579 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014580
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014581send-proxy-v2
14582 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14583 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14584 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14585 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014586 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14587 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14588 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14589 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014590
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014591proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014592 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14593 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14594
14595 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14596 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14597 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14598 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14599 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14600 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14601 connection is supported).
14602 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14603 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14604 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14605 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14606 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14607 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14608 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014609
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014610send-proxy-v2-ssl
14611 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14612 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14613 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14614 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14615 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14616 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14617 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014618 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14619 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014620
14621send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14622 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14623 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14624 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14625 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14626 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14627 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14628 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14629 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014630 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14631 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014633slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14635 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14636 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14637 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14638 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14639 parameters :
14640
14641 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14642 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14643
14644 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14645 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14646 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14647 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14648
14649 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14650 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14651 seen as failed.
14652
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014653sni <expression>
14654 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14655 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14656 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14657 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014658 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14659 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014660 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014661 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14662 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014663
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014664source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014665source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014666source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014667 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14668 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14669 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14670 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14671
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014672 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14673 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14674 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14675 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14676 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14677 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14678 server.
14679
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014680 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14681 specifying the source address without port(s).
14682
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014683ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014684 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14685 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14686 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14687 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14688 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14689 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014690 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14691 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014692
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014693ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14694 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14695 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14696 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14697
14698ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14699 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14700 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14701 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14702
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014703ssl-reuse
14704 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14705 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14706 default value.
14707 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14708 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14709
14710stick
14711 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14712 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14713 default value.
14714 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14715 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014716
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014717socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014718 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014719 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14720 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14721
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014722tcp-ut <delay>
14723 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14724 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14725 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014726 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014727 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14728 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14729 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14730 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14731 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14732 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14733 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14734 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14735 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14736
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014737tfo
14738 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14739 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14740 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14741 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14742 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014743 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014745track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014746 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14747 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14748 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14749 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014750 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14751
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014752tls-tickets
14753 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14754 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14755 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014756 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14757 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14758 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014759 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014760 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014761
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014762verify [none|required]
14763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014764 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014765 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14766 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014767 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014768 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14769 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14770 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14771 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14772 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14773 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14774 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14775 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014776
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014777verifyhost <hostname>
14778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014779 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14780 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14781 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14782 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14783 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14784 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14785 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14786 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014788weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014789 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14790 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14791 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014792 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14793 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14794 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14795 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14796 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14797 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014798
14799
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14801-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014802
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014803HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14804using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014805configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014806This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14807can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14808workload.
14809This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14810resolution at run time.
14811Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14812carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14813
14814
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148155.3.1. Global overview
14816----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014817
14818As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14819different steps of the process life:
14820
14821 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14822 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14823 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14824
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014825 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14826 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014827
14828A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14829 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14830 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14831 resolution to know this new IP.
14832
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014833When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014834HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014835SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14836from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14837will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14838will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014839
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014840A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014841 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014842 first valid response.
14843
14844 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14845 servers return an error.
14846
14847
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148485.3.2. The resolvers section
14849----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014850
14851This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014852HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14853contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014854
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014855When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14856uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14857is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14858answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14859
14860When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014861used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014862
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014863 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14864 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14865 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014866
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014867 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14868 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014869
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014870 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14871 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14872 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014873
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014874For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14875following scenarios are possible:
14876
14877 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14878 ignored
14879
14880 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14881 applied
14882
14883 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14884 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14885
14886 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14887 retries the query with a new type
14888
14889 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14890 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014891
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014892As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14893a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014894<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014895
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014896
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014897resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014899
14900A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14901
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014902accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014904 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014905 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14906 by RFC 6891)
14907
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014908 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14909 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14910 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14911 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14912 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14913 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014914
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014915nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14916 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14917 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14918 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14919 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14920 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14921 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14922 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14923 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14924 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014925 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14926
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014927parse-resolv-conf
14928 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14929 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14930 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14931
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014932hold <status> <period>
14933 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14934 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014935 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014936 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014937 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14938 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14939 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14940
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014941 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014942
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014943resolve_retries <nb>
14944 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14945 giving up.
14946 Default value: 3
14947
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014948 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14949 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14950 type.
14951
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014952timeout <event> <time>
14953 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14954 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14955 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014956 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14957 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014958 Default value: 1s
14959 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014960 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014961 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014962 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14963 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14964
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014965 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014966
14967 resolvers mydns
14968 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14969 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014970 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014971 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014972 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014973 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014974 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014975 hold other 30s
14976 hold refused 30s
14977 hold nx 30s
14978 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014979 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014980 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014981
14982
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200149836. Cache
14984---------
14985
14986HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14987(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14988RAM.
14989
14990The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14991this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14992
14993If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14994independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14995when we try to allocate a new one.
14996
14997The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14998
14999It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15000"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15001for more details.
15002
15003When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15004replaced by "<CACHE>".
15005
15006
150076.1. Limitation
15008----------------
15009
15010The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15011
15012- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015013- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15014 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15015 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015016- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15017- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015018- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15019 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15020 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015021- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15022 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015023- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15024 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15025 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015026
15027- If the request is not a GET
15028- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15029- If the request contains an Authorization header
15030
15031
150326.2. Setup
15033-----------
15034
15035To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15036the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15037
15038
150396.2.1. Cache section
15040---------------------
15041
15042cache <name>
15043 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15044 size of cache is mandatory.
15045
15046total-max-size <megabytes>
15047 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15048 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15049
15050max-object-size <bytes>
15051 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15052 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15053 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15054
15055max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015056 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015057 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15058 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15059 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15060 default.
15061
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015062process-vary <on/off>
15063 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015064 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15065 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15066 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015067 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015068
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015069max-secondary-entries <number>
15070 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15071 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15072 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15073
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015074
150756.2.2. Proxy section
15076---------------------
15077
15078http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15079 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15080 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15081 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15082 after this one.
15083
15084http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15085 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15086 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15087 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15088 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15089
15090
15091Example:
15092
15093 backend bck1
15094 mode http
15095
15096 http-request cache-use foobar
15097 http-response cache-store foobar
15098 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15099
15100 cache foobar
15101 total-max-size 4
15102 max-age 240
15103
15104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15106----------------------------------
15107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015108HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15110The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15111these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15112but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15113data called patterns.
15114
15115
151167.1. ACL basics
15117---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015118
15119The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15120content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15121from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15122simple :
15123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015125 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015126 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15127 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15130adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015131
15132In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015135
15136This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15137Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15138and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015139an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15140conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15141as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15142are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015143
15144ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15145'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15146which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15147
15148There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15149performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15152specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15153this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015154methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15155ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156
15157Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15158 - boolean
15159 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15160 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15161 - string
15162 - data block
15163
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015164Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15165converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15166would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15167The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15168which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15169
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015170Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15171keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15172fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15173which are summarized in the table below :
15174
15175 +---------------------+-----------------+
15176 | Sample or converter | Default |
15177 | output type | matching method |
15178 +---------------------+-----------------+
15179 | boolean | bool |
15180 +---------------------+-----------------+
15181 | integer | int |
15182 +---------------------+-----------------+
15183 | ip | ip |
15184 +---------------------+-----------------+
15185 | string | str |
15186 +---------------------+-----------------+
15187 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15188 +---------------------+-----------------+
15189
15190Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15191matching method, see below.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15194 - boolean
15195 - integer or integer range
15196 - IP address / network
15197 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15198 - regular expression
15199 - hex block
15200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015201The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15202
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015203 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15204 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015206 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015207 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015208 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015209 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15212read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15213if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15214lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15215will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15216beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15217a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15218lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15219exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15220
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015221The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15222parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15223ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15224a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15225check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15226
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015227The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15228socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15229file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15232loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15233
15234 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15235
15236In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15237the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15238case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15239as well.
15240
15241The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15242sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15243do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15244methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15245is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015246obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15248default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15249that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15250string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15251
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015252The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15253By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15254string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15255resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15256server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015257waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015258flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15259function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15262sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15263be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015264
15265 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15266 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15268 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15269 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15270 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015271
15272 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15273 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015275
15276 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015278
15279 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015282 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015283 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15284
15285 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15286 binary or string samples.
15287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15289 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15292 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15293 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15296 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15299 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15302 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15305 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015306 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015308 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15309 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15310 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015311
15312For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15313request, it is possible to do :
15314
15315 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15316
15317In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15318buffer, one would use the following acl :
15319
15320 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15321
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015322On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15323possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15324
15325 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15328criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15329method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15330to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15331criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15332the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015335the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15336For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15339 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15340 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15341 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015342
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015343
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015344The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15345types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15346combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15347brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15348default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 +-------------------------------------------------+
15351 | Input sample type |
15352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015353 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15355 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015357 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015359 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015361 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015363 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015365 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015367 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015369 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015371 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015373 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015375 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015377 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15379 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015381
15382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153837.1.1. Matching booleans
15384------------------------
15385
15386In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15387Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15388When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15389that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15390
15391Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15392return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15393"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153967.1.2. Matching integers
15397------------------------
15398
15399Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15400enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15401to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15402
15403Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15404matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15405lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015406
15407For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15408unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15409representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15410
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015411As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15412two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15413instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15414ranges and operators.
15415
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015416For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015417operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15418Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15419of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015421Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015422
15423 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15424 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15425 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15426 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15427 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015429For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015430
15431 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15432
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015433This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15434
15435 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154387.1.3. Matching strings
15439-----------------------
15440
15441String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15442different forms :
15443
15444 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015445 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446
15447 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015448 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449
15450 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15451 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15452
15453 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15454 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15455
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015456 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15458 matches.
15459
15460 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15461 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15462 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015463
15464String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15465exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15466characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15467string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15468to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015469before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015470
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015471Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15472(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15473Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15474
15475Example:
15476 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15477 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15478
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15481---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015482
15483Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15484they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15485possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15486passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15487the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015488the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15489match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015490
15491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15493-------------------------------------
15494
15495It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15496not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15497a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15498to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15499digits may be used upper or lower case.
15500
15501Example :
15502 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15503 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15504
15505
155067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15507---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015508
15509IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15510netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15511within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015512host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015513difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15514at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15515does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15516parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015517
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015518The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15519abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15520
15521 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15522 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15523 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15524 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15525 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15526 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15527 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15528 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15529
15530Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15531192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15532
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015533IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15534Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15535trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15536IPv6 patterns.
15537
15538HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15539following situations :
15540 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15541 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15542 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15543 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15544 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15545 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15546 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15547 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15548 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15549 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551
155527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15553----------------------------------
15554
15555Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15556combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15557
15558 - AND (implicit)
15559 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15560 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15567indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15570"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15571requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15572is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15573
15574 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015575 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15576 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15577 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578
15579To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15580and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15581
15582 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15583 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15584 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15585 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15586
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015587 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15589 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15590 use_backend www if host_www
15591
15592It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15593expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15594be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15595the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15596
15597 The following rule :
15598
15599 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015600 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601
15602 Can also be written that way :
15603
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015604 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605
15606It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15607to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15608simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15609sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15610good use is the following :
15611
15612 With named ACLs :
15613
15614 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15615 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15616 monitor fail if site_dead
15617
15618 With anonymous ACLs :
15619
15620 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15621
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015622See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15623keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624
15625
156267.3. Fetching samples
15627---------------------
15628
15629Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15630against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15631sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15632ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15633of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15634available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15635
15636This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15637Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15638compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15639deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15640
15641The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15642matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15643method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15644indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15645
15646As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15647when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15648mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15649the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15650ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15651
15652Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15653multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15654when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015655incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15656are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15658all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15659
15660Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15661 - name
15662 - name(arg1)
15663 - name(arg1,arg2)
15664
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015665
156667.3.1. Converters
15667-----------------
15668
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015669Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15670of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15671is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15672was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015673has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015674unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15675
15676These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15677sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15678the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015679support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015680
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015681A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15682support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15683supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15684(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15685bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015688
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001568951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15690 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15691 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15692 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15693 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15694 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15695
15696 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015697 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15698 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015699 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15700 frontend http-in
15701 bind *:8081
15702 default_backend servers
15703 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15704 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015706add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015707 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015708 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015709 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15710 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015711 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015712 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15713 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15714 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15715 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015717 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015718
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015719aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15720 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15721 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15722 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15723 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15724 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15725 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15726
15727 Example:
15728 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15729 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015731and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015732 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015733 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015734 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15735 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15738 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015742 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015743
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015744b64dec
15745 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15746 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015747 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15748 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015749
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015750base64
15751 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015752 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015753 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15754 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015755
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015756bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015757 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015758 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015759 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015760 presence of a flag).
15761
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015762bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15763 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15764 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015765 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015766
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015767concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15768 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15769 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15770 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15771 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15772 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15773 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15774 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15775 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15776 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15777 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015778 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015779 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015780 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15781 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015782
15783 Example:
15784 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15785 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15786 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015787 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015788 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15789
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015790cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015791 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15792 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015793
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015794crc32([<avalanche>])
15795 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15796 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15797 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15798 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15799 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15800 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15801 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15802 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15803 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15804 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015805 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15806
15807crc32c([<avalanche>])
15808 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15809 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15810 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15811 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15812 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15813 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15814 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15815 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015816
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015817cut_crlf
15818 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15819 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15820 updated.
15821
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015822da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015823 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15824 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15825 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15826 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015827 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015828 configuration language.
15829
15830 Example:
15831 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015832 bind *:8881
15833 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015834 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015835
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015836debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15837 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15838 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15839 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15840 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15841 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15842 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15843 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15844 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15845 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15846 printable sample types.
15847
15848 Example:
15849 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015850
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015851digest(<algorithm>)
15852 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15853 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15854
15855 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15856 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015858div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015859 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15860 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015861 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015862 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15863 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015864 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015865 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15866 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15867 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015869 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015870 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015872djb2([<avalanche>])
15873 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15874 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15875 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15876 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15877 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15878 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15879 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015880 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15881 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015882
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015883even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015884 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015885 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15886
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015887field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15888 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15889 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15890 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15891 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15892 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15893 fields.
15894
15895 Example :
15896 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15897 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15898 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15899 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15900 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015901
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015902fix_is_valid
15903 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15904 Information eXchange):
15905
15906 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15907 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015908 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015909 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015910 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015911 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15912 checksum
15913
15914 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15915 the server can be parsed.
15916
15917 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15918 message, false if not.
15919
15920 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15921
15922 Example:
15923 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15924 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15925
15926fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15927 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15928 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15929 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15930 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015931 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015932 added.
15933
15934 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15935 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15936 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15937 fix_is_valid converter.
15938
15939 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15940
15941 Example:
15942 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15943 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15944 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15945 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15946 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15947
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015948hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015949 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015950 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015951 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015952 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015953
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015954hex2i
15955 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015956 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015957
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015958htonl
15959 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15960 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15961 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15962 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15963
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015964hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015965 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15966 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15967 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15968 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15969
15970 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15971 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15972
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015973http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015974 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15975 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015976 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15977 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15978 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15979 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15980 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15981 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15982 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15983 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015985iif(<true>,<false>)
15986 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15987 string otherwise.
15988
15989 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015990 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015991
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015992in_table(<table>)
15993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15995 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015997 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15998
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015999ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016000 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016001 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016002 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16003 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16004 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16005 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16006 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016007
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016008json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016009 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016010 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016011 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016012 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16013 of errors:
16014 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16015 bytes, ...)
16016 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16017 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16018
16019 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16020 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16021 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16022 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16023 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16024 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016025 - "ascii" : never fails;
16026 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16027 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016028 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016029 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016030 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16031 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16032
16033 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016034 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016035
16036 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016037 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016038 capture request header user-agent len 150
16039 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016040
16041 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16042 GET / HTTP/1.0
16043 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16044
16045 Output log:
16046 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16047
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016048json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16049 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16050 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16051 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16052 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16053
16054 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16055 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16056
16057 Example:
16058 # get a integer value from the request body
16059 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16060 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16061
16062 # get a key with '.' in the name
16063 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16064 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16065
16066 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16067 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16068
16069 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16070 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16071
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016072language(<value>[,<default>])
16073 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16074 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16075 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16076 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16077 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16078 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16079 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16080 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16081 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016082 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016083 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16084 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016086 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016087
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016088 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16089 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016090
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016091 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16092 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16093 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16094 use_backend spanish if es
16095 use_backend french if fr
16096 use_backend english if en
16097 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016098
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016099length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016100 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16101 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16102 type. The result is of type integer.
16103
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016104lower
16105 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16106 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16107 type. The result is of type string.
16108
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016109ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16110 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16111 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16112 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16113 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16114 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16115 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16116
16117 Example :
16118
16119 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016120 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016121 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16122
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016123ltrim(<chars>)
16124 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16125 representation of the input sample.
16126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016127map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16128map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16129map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16130 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16131 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16132 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16133 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16134 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16135 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16136 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16137 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016139 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16140 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16141 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016142
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016143 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016144 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016145
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016146 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16147 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16148 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16149 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016150 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16151 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016152 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16153 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16154 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16155 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16156 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16157 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16158 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16159 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016160 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16161 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16162 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016163 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16164 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16165 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16166 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16167 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016168
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016169 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16170 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16171 the corresponding match text.
16172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016173 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16174 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16175 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16176 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16177 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016178
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016179 Example :
16180
16181 # this is a comment and is ignored
16182 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16183 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16184 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16185 | | | `---------- value
16186 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16187 | `---------------------------- key
16188 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16189
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016190mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016191 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16192 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016193 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016194 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016195 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016196 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16197 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16198 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16199 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016200 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016201 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016202
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016203mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16204 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16205 <packettype>.
16206 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16207 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16208 from.
16209 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16210 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16211 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16212
16213 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16214 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16215 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16216 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16217
16218 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16219 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16220 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16221 packets only):
16222 17: Session Expiry Interval
16223 33: Receive Maximum
16224 39: Maximum Packet Size
16225 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16226 25: Request Response Information
16227 23: Request Problem Information
16228 21: Authentication Method
16229 22: Authentication Data
16230 18: Will Delay Interval
16231 1: Payload Format Indicator
16232 2: Message Expiry Interval
16233 3: Content Type
16234 8: Response Topic
16235 9: Correlation Data
16236 Not supported yet:
16237 38: User Property
16238
16239 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16240 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16241 packets only):
16242 17: Session Expiry Interval
16243 33: Receive Maximum
16244 36: Maximum QoS
16245 37: Retain Available
16246 39: Maximum Packet Size
16247 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16248 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16249 31: Reason String
16250 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16251 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16252 42: Shared Subscription Available
16253 19: Server Keep Alive
16254 26: Response Information
16255 28: Server Reference
16256 21: Authentication Method
16257 22: Authentication Data
16258 Not supported yet:
16259 38: User Property
16260
16261 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16262 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16263 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16264 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16265
16266 Example:
16267
16268 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16269 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16270 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16271 if data_in_buffer
16272 # do the same as above
16273 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16274 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16275 if data_in_buffer
16276
16277mqtt_is_valid
16278 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16279
16280 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16281 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16282 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16283 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16284
16285 Example:
16286
16287 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16288 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16289
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016290mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016291 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016292 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16293 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016294 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016295 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016296 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016297 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16298 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16299 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16300 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016301 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016302 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016303
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016304nbsrv
16305 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16306 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16307 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16308 map lookup.
16309
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016310neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016311 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16312 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16313 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16314 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016315
16316not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016317 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016318 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016319 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016320 absence of a flag).
16321
16322odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016323 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016324 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16325
16326or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016327 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016328 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016329 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16330 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016331 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016332 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16333 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16334 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16335 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016337 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016338
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016339protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16340 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16341 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16342 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16343 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16344 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16345 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16346 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16347 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16348 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16349 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16350 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16351
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016352regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016353 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16354 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16355 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16356 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16357 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16358 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16359 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16360 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16361 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016362 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16363 of characters with other ones.
16364
16365 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16366 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16367 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16368 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16369 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16370 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016371
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016372 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016373
16374 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16375 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16376 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016377 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016378
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016379 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16380 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16381
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016382 # capture groups and backreferences
16383 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016384 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016385 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16386
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016387capture-req(<id>)
16388 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16389 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16390
16391 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016392 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16393 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016394
16395capture-res(<id>)
16396 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16397 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16398
16399 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016400 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16401 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016402
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016403rtrim(<chars>)
16404 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16405 of the input sample.
16406
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016407sdbm([<avalanche>])
16408 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16409 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16410 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16411 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16412 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16413 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16414 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016415 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16416 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016417
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016418secure_memcmp(<var>)
16419 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16420 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16421 match.
16422
16423 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16424 performed in constant time.
16425
16426 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16427 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16428
16429 Example :
16430
16431 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16432 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16433 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16434 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16435
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016436set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016437 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16438 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16439 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016440 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016441 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16442 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016443 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016444 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16445 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016446 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016447 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016448
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016449sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016450 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016451 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16452
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016453sha2([<bits>])
16454 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16455 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16456
16457 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16458 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16459
16460 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16461 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16462
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016463srv_queue
16464 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16465 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16466 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16467 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16468 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16469
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016470strcmp(<var>)
16471 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16472 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16473 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16474 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16475 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16476 shorter).
16477
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016478 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16479 strings in constant time.
16480
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016481 Example :
16482
16483 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16484 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16485 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16486
16487
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016488sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016489 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16490 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016491 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016492 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16493 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016494 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016495 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16496 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016497 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016498 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16499 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016501 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016502
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016503table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16504 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16505 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16506 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16507 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16508 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16509 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16510
16511
16512table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16513 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16514 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16515 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16516 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16517 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16518 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16519
16520table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016523 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016524 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16525 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16526
16527table_conn_cur(<table>)
16528 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16529 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16530 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16531 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16532 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16533
16534table_conn_rate(<table>)
16535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16537 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16538 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16539 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16540
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016541table_gpt0(<table>)
16542 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16543 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16544 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16545 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16546 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16547
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016548table_gpc0(<table>)
16549 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16550 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16551 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16552 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16553 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16554
16555table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16556 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16557 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16558 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16559 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16560 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16561 sample fetch keyword.
16562
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016563table_gpc1(<table>)
16564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16566 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16567 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16568 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16569
16570table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16571 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16572 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16573 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16574 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16575 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16576 sample fetch keyword.
16577
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016578table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16579 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16580 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016581 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016582 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16583 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16584
16585table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16586 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16587 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16588 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16589 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16590 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16591 keyword.
16592
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016593table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16594 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16595 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16596 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16597 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16598 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16599
16600table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16601 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16602 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16603 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16604 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16605 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16606 keyword.
16607
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016608table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16609 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16610 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016611 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016612 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16613 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16614
16615table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16616 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16617 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16618 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16619 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16620 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16621 keyword.
16622
16623table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16624 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16625 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016626 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016627 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16628 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16629 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16630 keyword.
16631
16632table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016636 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16637 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16638 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16639 keyword.
16640
16641table_server_id(<table>)
16642 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16643 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16644 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16645 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16646 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16647 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16648
16649table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16650 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16651 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016652 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016653 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16654 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16655 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16656 keyword.
16657
16658table_sess_rate(<table>)
16659 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16660 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16661 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16662 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16663 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16664 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16665 keyword.
16666
16667table_trackers(<table>)
16668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16670 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16671 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16672 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16673 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16674 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16675 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16676 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16677 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16678
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016679ub64dec
16680 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16681 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16682 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16683
16684 Example:
16685 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16686 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16687
16688ub64enc
16689 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16690
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016691upper
16692 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16693 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16694 type. The result is of type string.
16695
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016696url_dec([<in_form>])
16697 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16698 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16699 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16700 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16701 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16702 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016703
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016704url_enc([<enc_type>])
16705 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16706 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16707 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16708 optional argument is here for future changes.
16709
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016710ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016711 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016712 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16713 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16714 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016715 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16716 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16717 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16718 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016719 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016720 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16721 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016722
16723 Example:
16724 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16725 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16726
16727 message Point {
16728 int32 latitude = 1;
16729 int32 longitude = 2;
16730 }
16731
16732 message PPoint {
16733 Point point = 59;
16734 }
16735
16736 message Rectangle {
16737 // One corner of the rectangle.
16738 PPoint lo = 48;
16739 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16740 PPoint hi = 49;
16741 }
16742
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016743 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16744 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16745 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016746
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016747 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16748 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016749 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016750 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16751
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016752 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016753
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016754 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016755
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016756 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16757 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16758 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016759
16760 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16761 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16762 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16763
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016764 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16765 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16766 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016767
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016768
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016769unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016770 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16771 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16772 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16773 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16774 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16775 response),
16776 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16777 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16778 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16779 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16780
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016781utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16782 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16783 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16784 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16785 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16786 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16787 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16788
16789 Example :
16790
16791 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016792 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016793 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16794
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016795word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16796 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16797 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16798 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016799 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016800 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16801 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16802
16803 Example :
16804 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16805 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16806 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16807 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16808 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016809 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016810
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016811wt6([<avalanche>])
16812 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16813 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16814 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16815 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16816 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16817 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16818 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016819 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16820 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016821
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016822xor(<value>)
16823 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016824 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016825 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016826 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016830 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016831 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16832 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016834 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016835
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016836xxh3([<seed>])
16837 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16838 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16839 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16840 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16841 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16842 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16843 considered as cryptographically secure.
16844
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016845xxh32([<seed>])
16846 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16847 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16848 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16849 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16850 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16851 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16852 as cryptographically secure.
16853
16854xxh64([<seed>])
16855 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16856 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16857 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16858 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16859 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16860 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16861 as cryptographically secure.
16862
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016863
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168647.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865--------------------------------------------
16866
16867A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16868not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16869"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16870The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16871
16872always_false : boolean
16873 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16874 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16875
16876always_true : boolean
16877 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16878 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16879
16880avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016881 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16883 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16884 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16885 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16886 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16887 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16888 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16889 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16890 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16891 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16892 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16893 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16894 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016897 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16898 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16899 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16900 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016901 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16902
16903be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16904 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16905 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16906 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16907 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16908 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016909 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16910 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016911
16912 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16913 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16914 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16918 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16919 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016920 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16922 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016923
16924 Example :
16925 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16926 backend dynamic
16927 mode http
16928 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16929 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016931bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016932 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16933 of the string.
16934
16935bool(<bool>) : bool
16936 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16937 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16940 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016941 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016942 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16943 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016944
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016945 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016946 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016947 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16948
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016949 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16950 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016951
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016952 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016953 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016955 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016956 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016957 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016958 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016959
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016960 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16961 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016962 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016963 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016964
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016965cpu_calls : integer
16966 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16967 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16968 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16969 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16970 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16971 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16972
16973cpu_ns_avg : integer
16974 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16975 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16976 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16977 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16978 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16979 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16980 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16981 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16982 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16983 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16984 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16985
16986cpu_ns_tot : integer
16987 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16988 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16989 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16990 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16991 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16992 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16993 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16994 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16995 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16996 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16997 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16998 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16999 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17000
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017001date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017002 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017003
17004 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17005 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17006 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017007 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17008
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017009 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17010 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17011 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17012 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17013 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17014
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017015 Example :
17016
17017 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17018 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017019
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017020 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17021 # millisecond granularity
17022 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17023
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017024date_us : integer
17025 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17026 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17027 from the same timeval structure.
17028
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017029distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17030 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17031 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17032 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17033 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17034 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17035 list of supported tokens.
17036
17037distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17038 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17039 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17040 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17041 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17042 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17043 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17044 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17045 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17046 supported tokens.
17047
17048 Example :
17049 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17050 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17051 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17052 # send large files to the big farm
17053 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17054
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017055env(<name>) : string
17056 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17057 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17058 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17059 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17060 certain way.
17061
17062 Examples :
17063 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17064 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17065
17066 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17067 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017069fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17070 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017071 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17072 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17074 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017076 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17077 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017078
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017079fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17081 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17082 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017084fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17085 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17086 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17087 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17088 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17089 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17090 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17091 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17092 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017093
17094 Example :
17095 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17096 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17097 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17098 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17099 frontend mail
17100 bind :25
17101 mode tcp
17102 maxconn 100
17103 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17104 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17105 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17106 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017107
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017108hostname : string
17109 Returns the system hostname.
17110
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017111int(<integer>) : signed integer
17112 Returns a signed integer.
17113
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017114ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17115 Returns an ipv4.
17116
17117ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17118 Returns an ipv6.
17119
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017120lat_ns_avg : integer
17121 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17122 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17123 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17124 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17125 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17126 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17127 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17128 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17129 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017130 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17131 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17132 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17133 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17134 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17135 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017136
17137lat_ns_tot : integer
17138 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17139 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17140 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17141 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17142 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17143 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17144 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17145 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17146 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017147 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17148 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17149 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17150 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17151 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017152 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17153 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17154 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17155 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17156 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17157 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17158
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017159meth(<method>) : method
17160 Returns a method.
17161
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017162nbproc : integer
17163 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17164 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17165 and debugging purposes.
17166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17168 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17169 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17170 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017171 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17172 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17173 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017174
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017175prio_class : integer
17176 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17177 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17178 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17179
17180prio_offset : integer
17181 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17182 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17183 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17184 set-priority-offset".
17185
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017186proc : integer
17187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17188 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17189 debugging purposes.
17190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017191queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017192 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17193 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17194 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17196 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17197 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17198 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17199 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17200
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017201rand([<range>]) : integer
17202 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17203 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17204 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17205 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17206 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17207
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017208uuid([<version>]) : string
17209 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17210 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17211 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17215 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17216 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17217 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17218 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017219 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17220 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17221
17222srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17224 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17225 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17226 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17227 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17228 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17229 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17230
17231 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17232 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233
17234srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17235 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17236 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17237 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017238 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17240 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17241 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17242
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017243srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17244 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17245 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17246 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17247 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17248 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17249 fetch methods.
17250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017251srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17252 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17253 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017254 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17256 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017257 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258 overloading servers).
17259
17260 Example :
17261 # Redirect to a separate back
17262 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17263 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17264 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17265
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017266srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17267 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17268 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17269 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17270
17271srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17272 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17273 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17274 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17275
17276srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17277 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17278 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17279 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17280
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017281stopping : boolean
17282 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17283 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17284 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17285
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017286str(<string>) : string
17287 Returns a string.
17288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17290 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17291 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17292
17293table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17294 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17295 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17296 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17297
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017298thread : integer
17299 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17300 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17301 and debugging purposes.
17302
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017303var(<var-name>) : undefined
17304 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017305 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17306 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017310 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017313 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017314 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173167.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317----------------------------------
17318
17319The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17320closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17321methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17322sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17323TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017324the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17325counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017326"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17327used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17328can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17329Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17330table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17331tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17332currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017334bc_dst : ip
17335 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17336 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17337 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17338 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17339
17340bc_dst_port : integer
17341 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17342 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17343
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017344bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017345 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17346 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17347 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17348
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017349bc_src : ip
17350 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17351 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17352 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17353 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17354
17355bc_src_port : integer
17356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17357 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017359be_id : integer
17360 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017361 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17362 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017363
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017364be_name : string
17365 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017366 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17367 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017368
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017369be_server_timeout : integer
17370 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17371 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17372 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17373
17374be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17375 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17376 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17377 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17378
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017379cur_server_timeout : integer
17380 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17381 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17382 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17383
17384cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17385 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17386 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17387 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389dst : ip
17390 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17391 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17392 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17393 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017394 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17395 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17396 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17397 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17398 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17399 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400
17401dst_conn : integer
17402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17403 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17404 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17405 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17406 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17407 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17408 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17409 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017410
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017411dst_is_local : boolean
17412 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17413 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17414 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17415 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017416 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017417 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17418 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17419 it only once per connection.
17420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421dst_port : integer
17422 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17423 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17424 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17425 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17426 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17427 an HTTP header.
17428
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017429fc_http_major : integer
17430 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17431 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17432 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17433
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017434fc_pp_authority : string
17435 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17436 if any.
17437
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017438fc_pp_unique_id : string
17439 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17440 if any.
17441
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017442fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17443 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17444 header.
17445
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017446fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17447 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17448 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17449 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17450 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17451 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17452 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17453
17454fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17455 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17456 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17457 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17458 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17459 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17460 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17461
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017462fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017463 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17464 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17465 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17466 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17467
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017468fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017469 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17470 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17471 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17472 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17473
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017474fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017475 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17476 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17477 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17478 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17479
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017480fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017481 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17482 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17483 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17484 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17485
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017486fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017487 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17488 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17489 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17490 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17491
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017492fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017493 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17494 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17495 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17496 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17497
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017498fe_defbe : string
17499 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17500 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017502fe_id : integer
17503 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017504 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017505 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17506
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017507fe_name : string
17508 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17509 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17510 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17511
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017512fe_client_timeout : integer
17513 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17514 current frontend.
17515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017516sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017517sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17518sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17519sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017520 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17521 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17522 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17523
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017524sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017525sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17526sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17527sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017528 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17529 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17530 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17531
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017532sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017533sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17534sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17535sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017536 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17537 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017538 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17539 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17540 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017541
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017542 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017543 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17544 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017545 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17546 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17547 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017548 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17549 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17550
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017551sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17552sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17553sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17554sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17555 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17556 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17557 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17558 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17559 when a first ACL was verified.
17560
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017561sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017562sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17563sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17564sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017565 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017566 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17567
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017568sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017569sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17570sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17571sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017572 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17573 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17574 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17575
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017576sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017577sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17578sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17579sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017580 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17581 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17582 See also src_conn_rate.
17583
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017584sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017585sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17586sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17587sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017588 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017589 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017590
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017591sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17592sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17593sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17594sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17595 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17596 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17597
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017598sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17599sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17600sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17601sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17602 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17603 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17604
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017605sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017606sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17607sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17608sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017609 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17610 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17611 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017612 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17613 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17614 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017615
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017616sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17617sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17618sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17619sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17620 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17621 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17622 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17623 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17624 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17625 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17626
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017627sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017628sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17629sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17630sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017631 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017632 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17633 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17634
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017635sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017636sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17637sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17638sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017639 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17640 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17641 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17642 src_http_err_rate.
17643
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017644sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17645sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17646sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17647sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17648 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17649 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17650 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17651
17652sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17653sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17654sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17655sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17656 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17657 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17658 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17659 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017661sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017662sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17663sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17664sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017666 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17667 src_http_req_cnt.
17668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017669sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017670sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17671sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17672sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017673 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17674 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17675 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17676 src_http_req_rate.
17677
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017678sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017679sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17680sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17681sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017682 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017683 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17684 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17685 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17686 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017687
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017688 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017689 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17690 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017691 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17692
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017693sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17694sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17695sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17696sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17697 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17698 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17699 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17700 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17701 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017703sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017704sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17705sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17706sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017707 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17708 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17709 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017710
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017711sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017712sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17713sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17714sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017715 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17716 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17717 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017718
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017719sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017720sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17721sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17722sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017723 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017724 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17725 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17726 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017727 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017728 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17729
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017730sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017731sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17732sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17733sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017734 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17735 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17736 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17737 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17738 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017739 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017740
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017741sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017742sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17743sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17744sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017745 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17746 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17747 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17748
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017749sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017750sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17751sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17752sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017753 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17754 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017755 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017756 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17757 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17759 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17760 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017762so_id : integer
17763 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17764 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17765 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017766
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017767so_name : string
17768 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17769 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17770 strings instead of integers.
17771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017772src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017773 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017774 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17775 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17776 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017777 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17778 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17779 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017780 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17781 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17782 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17783 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17784 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17785 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17786 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017787
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017788 Example:
17789 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17790 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017792src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17793 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17794 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17795 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017796 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17799 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17800 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017801 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017802 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017804src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17805 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17806 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17807 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17808 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17809 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17810 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017811
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017812 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017813 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17814 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17815 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17816 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017817 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017818 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17819 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17820
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017821src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17822 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17823 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17824 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17825 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17826 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17827 was verified.
17828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017830 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017832 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017833 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017836 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17838 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017839 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17842 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17843 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17844 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017845 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017848 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017850 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017851 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017852
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017853src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17854 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17855 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17856 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17857 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17858
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017859src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17860 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17861 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17862 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17863 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017866 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017868 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17869 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017870 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17871 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17872 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017873
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017874src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17875 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17876 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17877 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17878 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17879 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17880 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17881 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017885 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017886 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017887 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017888 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17891 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17892 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17893 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17894 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017895 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017896
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017897src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17898 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17899 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017900 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017901 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17902 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17903
17904src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17905 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17906 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17907 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17908 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17909 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17910 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017913 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17915 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017916 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17919 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17920 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17921 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017922 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017923 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17926 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17927 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17928 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017929 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017930 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17931 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017932
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017933 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017934 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017935 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017936 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017937
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017938src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17939 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17940 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17941 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17942 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17943 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17944 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17945
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017946src_is_local : boolean
17947 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17948 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17949 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17950 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017951 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017952 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17953 once per connection.
17954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017955src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017956 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17957 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17958 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17959 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17960 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017963 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17964 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17965 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17966 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17967 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969src_port : integer
17970 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17971 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17972 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17973 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017976 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017977 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17978 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17979 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017980 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17984 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17985 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17986 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017987 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17990 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17991 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17992 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17993 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17994 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17995 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17996 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17997 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017998
17999 Example :
18000 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18001 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18002 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18003 listen ssh
18004 bind :22
18005 mode tcp
18006 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018007 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018008 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018009 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011srv_id : integer
18012 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18013 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018014 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018015
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018016srv_name : string
18017 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18018 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018019 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018020
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180217.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018024The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18025closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18026when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18027usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018028future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018029
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001803051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18031 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18032 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18033 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18034 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18035 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18036
18037 Example :
18038 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18039 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18040 # the request.
18041 frontend http-in
18042 bind *:8081
18043 default_backend servers
18044 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18045 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18046
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018047ssl_bc : boolean
18048 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18049 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018050 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18051 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018052
18053ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18054 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018055 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18056 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018057
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018058ssl_bc_alpn : string
18059 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18060 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018061 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018062 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18063 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18064 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18065 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18066 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018067 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18068 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018069
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018070ssl_bc_cipher : string
18071 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018072 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18073 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018074
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018075ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18076 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18077 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18078 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018079 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018080
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018081ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18082 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18083 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018084 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18085 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018086
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018087ssl_bc_npn : string
18088 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18089 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018090 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018091 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18092 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18093 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18094 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018095 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18096 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018097
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018098ssl_bc_protocol : string
18099 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018100 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18101 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018102
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018103ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018104 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018105 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018106 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18107 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018108
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018109ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18110 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18111 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18112 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018113 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018114
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018115ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18116 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18117 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018118 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18119 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018120
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018121ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18122 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18123 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18124 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018125 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018126
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018127ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18128 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018129 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18130 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18133 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18134 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18135 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18136 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18137 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018139ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18140 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18141 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18142 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18143 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018144
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018145ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018146 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18147 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18148 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018149 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018150 does not support resumed sessions.
18151
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018152ssl_c_der : binary
18153 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18154 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18155 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018157ssl_c_err : integer
18158 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18159 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18160 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18161 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18162 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018163
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018164ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18166 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18167 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18168 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18169 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18170 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18171 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18172 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018173 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18174 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18175 LDAP v3.
18176 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18177 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179ssl_c_key_alg : string
18180 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18181 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18182 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018184ssl_c_notafter : string
18185 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18186 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18187 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189ssl_c_notbefore : string
18190 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18191 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18192 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018193
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018194ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18196 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18197 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18198 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18199 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18200 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18201 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18202 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018203 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18204 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18205 LDAP v3.
18206 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18207 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018209ssl_c_serial : binary
18210 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18211 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18212 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18215 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18216 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18217 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018218 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18219 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18220
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018221 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018222 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18225 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18226 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18227 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229ssl_c_used : boolean
18230 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18231 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233ssl_c_verify : integer
18234 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18235 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18236 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18237 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239ssl_c_version : integer
18240 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18241 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018242
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018243ssl_f_der : binary
18244 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18245 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18246 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18247
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018248ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018249 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18250 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18251 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18252 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018253 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18255 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18256 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018257 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18258 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18259 LDAP v3.
18260 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18261 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263ssl_f_key_alg : string
18264 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18265 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18266 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018268ssl_f_notafter : string
18269 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18270 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18271 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273ssl_f_notbefore : string
18274 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18275 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18276 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018277
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018278ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18280 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18281 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18282 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18283 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18284 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18285 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18286 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018287 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18288 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18289 LDAP v3.
18290 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18291 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293ssl_f_serial : binary
18294 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18295 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18296 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018297
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018298ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18299 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18300 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18301 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18304 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18305 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18306 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308ssl_f_version : integer
18309 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18310 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18311
18312ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018313 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18314 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18315 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317 Example :
18318 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18319 listen http-https
18320 bind :80
18321 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18322 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18323
18324ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18325 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18326 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18327
18328ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018329 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18331 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18332 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18333 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18334 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18335 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18336 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18337 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339ssl_fc_cipher : string
18340 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18341 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018342
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018343ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18344 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18345 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018346 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018347
18348ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18349 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18350 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018351 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018352
18353ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18354 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18355 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18356 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018357 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018358 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018359
18360ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18361 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18362 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018363 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018364
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018365ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18366 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18367 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18368 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18369
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018370ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18371 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18372 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18373 transport layer.
18374 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18375 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18376 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18377 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18378
18379ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18380 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18381 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18382 transport layer.
18383 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18384 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18385 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18386 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18387
18388ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18389 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18390 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18391 transport layer.
18392 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18393 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18394 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18395 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18396
18397ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18398 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18399 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18400 transport layer.
18401 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18402 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18403 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18404 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18405
18406ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18407 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18408 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18409 transport layer.
18410 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18411 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18412 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18413 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018416 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18417 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018418 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18419 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18420 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18421 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018422
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018423ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18424 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18425 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18426 wait until the handshake happened.
18427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018428ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18429 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018430 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18431 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018432 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018433 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018434
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018435ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018436 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018437 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18438 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018440ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018441 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018442 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18443 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18444 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18445 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18446 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18447 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18448 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018450ssl_fc_protocol : string
18451 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18452 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018453
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018454ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018455 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018456 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18457 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018458
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018459ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18460 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18461 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18462 transport layer.
18463 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18464 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18465 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18466 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18467
18468ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18469 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18470 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18471 transport layer.
18472 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18473 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18474 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18475 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18476
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018477ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18478 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18479 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18480 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18483 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18484 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18485 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18486 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018487
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018488ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18489 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18490 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18491 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18492 BoringSSL.
18493
18494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495ssl_fc_sni : string
18496 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18497 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18498 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18499 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18500 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18501
18502 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18503 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18504 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018505 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018506 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018508 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018509 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18510 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018512ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18513 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18514 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018515
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018516ssl_s_der : binary
18517 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18518 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18519 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18520
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018521ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18522 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18523 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18524 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018525 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018526 does not support resumed sessions.
18527
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018528ssl_s_key_alg : string
18529 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18530 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18531 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18532
18533ssl_s_notafter : string
18534 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18535 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18536 transport layer.
18537
18538ssl_s_notbefore : string
18539 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18540 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18541 transport layer.
18542
18543ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18544 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18545 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18546 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18547 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18548 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18549 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018550 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18551 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018552 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18553 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18554 LDAP v3.
18555 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18556 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18557
18558ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18559 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18560 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18561 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18562 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18563 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18564 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018565 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18566 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018567 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18568 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18569 LDAP v3.
18570 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18571 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18572
18573ssl_s_serial : binary
18574 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18575 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18576 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18577
18578ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18579 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18580 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18581 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18582
18583ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18584 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18585 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18586 layer.
18587
18588ssl_s_version : integer
18589 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18590 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18596sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18597only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18598For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18599be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18600can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18601sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18602for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18603content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018604
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018605Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18606 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18607 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18608 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18609 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18610 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18611 sample expression). So be careful.
18612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018614 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18616 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18619 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018620 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623req.len : integer
18624req_len : integer (deprecated)
18625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18626 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18627 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18628 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18629 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18630 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18631 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18632 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18635 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018636 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18637 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18638 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18639 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641 ACL alternatives :
18642 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18645 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18646 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18647 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18648 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650 ACL alternatives :
18651 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655req.proto_http : boolean
18656req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18657 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18658 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18659 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18660 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18661 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18662 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18663 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665 Example:
18666 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18667 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18668 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018669 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18672rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18673 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18674 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18675 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18676 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18677 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18678 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18679 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018681 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18682 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18683 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18684 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18685 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18686 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688 ACL derivatives :
18689 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691 Example :
18692 listen tse-farm
18693 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18694 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18695 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18696 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18697 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18698 persist rdp-cookie
18699 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18700 # This is only useful makes sense if
18701 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18702 stick-table type string size 204800
18703 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18704 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18705 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18708 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18711rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18712 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18713 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18714 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18715 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717 ACL derivatives :
18718 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018719
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018720req.ssl_alpn : string
18721 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18722 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18723 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18724 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18725 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18726 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018727 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018728
18729 Examples :
18730 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18731 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18732 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018733 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018734 default_backend bk_default
18735
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018736req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18737 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18738 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018739 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18740 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18741 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18742 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18743 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018745req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18746req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18747 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18748 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18749 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18750 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18751 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18752 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18753 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755req.ssl_sni : string
18756req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18757 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18758 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18759 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18760 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18761 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018762 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18763 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18764 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18765 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18766 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18767 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18768 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18769 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18770 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772 ACL derivatives :
18773 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775 Examples :
18776 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18777 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18778 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18779 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18780 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018781
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018782req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18783 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18784 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18785 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18786 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18787 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18788 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18789 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18790 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18791 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793req.ssl_ver : integer
18794req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18795 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18796 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18797 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18798 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18799 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18800 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18801 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018802 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805 ACL derivatives :
18806 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018807
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018808res.len : integer
18809 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18810 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18811 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18812 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18813 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18814 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18815 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018816 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18819 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018820 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018821 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018822 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018823 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18826 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18827 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18828 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018829 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18830 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018833
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018834res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18835rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18836 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18837 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18838 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18839 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18840 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18841 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18842 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844wait_end : boolean
18845 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18846 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018847 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18849 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018850 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018851 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18852 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018854 Examples :
18855 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18856 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18857 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18860 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18861 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18862 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18863 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18864 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18865 tcp-request content reject
18866
18867
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188687.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869--------------------------------------
18870
18871It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18872This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18873data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18874its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18875HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18876content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18877to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18878more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18879response are indexed.
18880
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018881Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18882 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18883 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18884 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18885 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18886 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18887 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889base : string
18890 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18891 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18892 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18893 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18894 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18895 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18896 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18897 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18898
18899 ACL derivatives :
18900 base : exact string match
18901 base_beg : prefix match
18902 base_dir : subdir match
18903 base_dom : domain match
18904 base_end : suffix match
18905 base_len : length match
18906 base_reg : regex match
18907 base_sub : substring match
18908
18909base32 : integer
18910 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18911 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18912 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018913 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18914 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18915 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018916
18917base32+src : binary
18918 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18919 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18920 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18921 per-URL counters.
18922
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018923baseq : string
18924 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18925 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18926 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18927 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18928
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018929capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18930 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18931 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18932 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18933
18934capture.req.method : string
18935 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18936 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18937 because it's allocated.
18938
18939capture.req.uri : string
18940 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18941 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18942 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18943 allocated.
18944
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018945capture.req.ver : string
18946 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18947 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18948 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18949
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018950capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18951 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18952 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18953 The first entry is an index of 0.
18954 See also: "capture response header"
18955
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018956capture.res.ver : string
18957 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18958 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18959 persistent flag.
18960
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018961req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018962 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18963 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18964 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018965
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018966req.body_param([<name>) : string
18967 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18968 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18969 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18970 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18971 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18972 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18973 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18974 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18975 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18976 given.
18977
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018978req.body_len : integer
18979 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18980 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018981 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18982 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018983
18984req.body_size : integer
18985 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018986 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18987 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018989req.cook([<name>]) : string
18990cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18991 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18992 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18993 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18994 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18995 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18996 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18997 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18998 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18999
19000 ACL derivatives :
19001 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19002 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19003 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19004 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19005 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19006 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19007 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19008 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19011cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19012 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19013 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19016cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19017 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19018 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19019 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19020 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19023 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19024 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19025 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19026 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019027 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019028 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19029 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19030 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19031 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019033hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19034 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19035 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19036 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19037 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019038 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019040req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019041 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19042 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19043 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19044 with headers such as User-Agent.
19045
19046 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19047 found.
19048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019049 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19050 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19051 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019052 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19055 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19056 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019057 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19058 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019061 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19062 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19063 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19064 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19065 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19066 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19067 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19068
19069 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19070 found.
19071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19073 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19074 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019075 with -1 being the last one.
19076
19077 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19078 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080 ACL derivatives :
19081 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19082 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19083 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19084 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19085 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19086 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19087 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19088 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19089
19090req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19091hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19092 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19093 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019094 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19095 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19096 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19097
19098 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19099 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19100 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19101
19102 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019103
19104req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19105hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19106 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19107 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19108 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019109 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19110 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19111 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19112 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19113 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019114
19115 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19116
19117 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118
19119req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19120hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19121 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19122 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19123 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019124
19125 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19126
19127 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019129req.hdrs : string
19130 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19131 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19132 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19133 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19134
19135req.hdrs_bin : binary
19136 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19137 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19138 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19139 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19140 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19141 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19142
19143 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019144
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019145 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19146 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19149 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19150 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19151 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19152 basic auth is supported.
19153
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019154http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19155 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19156 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19157 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19158 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19160 basic auth is supported.
19161
19162 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019163 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19164 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19165 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19166 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019167
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019168http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019169 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19170 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19171 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019172
19173http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019174 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19175 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19176 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019177
19178http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019179 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19180 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19181 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019184 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19185 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19187 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189method : integer + string
19190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19191 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19192 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19193 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19194 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19195 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19196 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198 ACL derivatives :
19199 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019201 Example :
19202 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19203 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19204 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019206path : string
19207 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19208 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19209 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19210 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19211 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019212 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215 ACL derivatives :
19216 path : exact string match
19217 path_beg : prefix match
19218 path_dir : subdir match
19219 path_dom : domain match
19220 path_end : suffix match
19221 path_len : length match
19222 path_reg : regex match
19223 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019224
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019225pathq : string
19226 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19227 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19228 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19229 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19230 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19231 result in both cases.
19232
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019233query : string
19234 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19235 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19236 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19237 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019238 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019239 which stops before the question mark.
19240
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019241req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19242 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19243 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19244 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19245 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019247req.ver : string
19248req_ver : string (deprecated)
19249 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19250 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19251 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253 ACL derivatives :
19254 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019255
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019256res.body : binary
19257 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19258 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019259 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19260
19261 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019262
19263res.body_len : integer
19264 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19265 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019266 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19267
19268 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019269
19270res.body_size : integer
19271 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19272 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19273 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19274 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019275 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19276
19277 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019278
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019279res.cache_hit : boolean
19280 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19281 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19282
19283res.cache_name : string
19284 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19285 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19286 empty string.
19287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019288res.comp : boolean
19289 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19290 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19291 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293res.comp_algo : string
19294 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19295 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19296 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298res.cook([<name>]) : string
19299scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19300 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19301 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019302 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19303
19304 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306 ACL derivatives :
19307 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019309res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19310scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19311 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19312 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019313 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19314
19315 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19318scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19319 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19320 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019321 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19322
19323 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019326 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19327 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19328
19329 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19330 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19331
19332 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19333
19334 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019337 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19338 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19339
19340 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19341 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19342
19343 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019345res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19346shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019347 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19348 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19349
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019350 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019351 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19352
19353 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355 ACL derivatives :
19356 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19357 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19358 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19359 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19360 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19361 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19362 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19363 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19364
19365res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19366shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019367 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19368 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19369
19370 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019371 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019372
19373 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019375res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19376shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019377 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19378 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19379
19380 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19381
19382 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019383
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019384res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19385 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19386 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19387 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019388 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19389
19390 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19393shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019394 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19395 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19396
19397 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19398
19399 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019400
19401res.hdrs : string
19402 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19403 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19404 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019405 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19406
19407 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019408
19409res.hdrs_bin : binary
19410 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19411 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19412 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19413 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19414 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19415 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19416 (length of 0 for both).
19417
19418 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19419
19420 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19421 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019423res.ver : string
19424resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19425 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019426 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19427
19428 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430 ACL derivatives :
19431 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019433set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19434 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19435 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019436 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019439 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19440 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019442status : integer
19443 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19444 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019445 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19446
19447 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019448
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019449unique-id : string
19450 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19451 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19452 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19453 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19454 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19455 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457url : string
19458 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19459 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19460 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19461 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19462 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19463 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19464 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466 ACL derivatives :
19467 url : exact string match
19468 url_beg : prefix match
19469 url_dir : subdir match
19470 url_dom : domain match
19471 url_end : suffix match
19472 url_len : length match
19473 url_reg : regex match
19474 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476url_ip : ip
19477 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19478 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19479 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19480 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19481 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19482 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19483 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485url_port : integer
19486 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19487 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19488 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19489 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019490
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019491urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19492url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019493 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19494 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019495 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19496 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19497 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19498 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19500 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019501 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19502 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504 ACL derivatives :
19505 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19506 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19507 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19508 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19509 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19510 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19511 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19512 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019513
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019515 Example :
19516 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19517 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19518 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19519 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019520
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019521urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019522 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19523 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19524 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019525
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019526url32 : integer
19527 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19528 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19529 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19530 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19531 is an unsigned integer.
19532
19533url32+src : binary
19534 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19535 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19536 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19537
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019538
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200195397.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019540---------------------------------------
19541
19542This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19543used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19544purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19545There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19546or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19547any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19548for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19549
19550internal.htx.data : integer
19551 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19552 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19553
19554internal.htx.free : integer
19555 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19556 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19557
19558internal.htx.free_data : integer
19559 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19560 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19561
19562internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019563 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19564 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19565 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019566
19567internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19568 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19569 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19570
19571internal.htx.size : integer
19572 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19573 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19574
19575internal.htx.used : integer
19576 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19577 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19578 direction.
19579
19580internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19581 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19582 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19583 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19584 of the special value :
19585 * head : The oldest inserted block
19586 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019587 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019588
19589internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19590 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19591 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19592 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19593 integer or one of the special value :
19594 * head : The oldest inserted block
19595 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019596 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019597
19598internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19599 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19600 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19601 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19602 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19603
19604 * head : The oldest inserted block
19605 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019606 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019607
19608internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19609 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19610 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19611 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19612 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19613
19614 * head : The oldest inserted block
19615 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019616 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019617
19618internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19619 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19620 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19621 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19622 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19623
19624 * head : The oldest inserted block
19625 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019626 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019627
19628internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19629 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19630 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19631 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19632 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19633
19634 * head : The oldest inserted block
19635 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019636 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019637
19638internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19639 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19640 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19641 it returns false.
19642
19643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200196447.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019645---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019647Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19648every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019649order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019651ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019652---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19653FALSE always_false never match
19654HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19655HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19656HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019657HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019658HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19659HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19660HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19661HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19662LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19663METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19664METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19665METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19666METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19667METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19668METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19669METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19670METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19671RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19672REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19673TRUE always_true always match
19674WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19675---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019676
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196788. Logging
19679----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019681One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19682provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19683very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19684provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19685state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019686to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019687headers.
19688
19689In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19690about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19691send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19692
19693 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19694 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19695 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19696 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19697 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019698 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019699 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700
19701The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19702allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19703as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19704while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19705real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19706delay.
19707
19708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197098.1. Log levels
19710---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019711
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019712TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019713source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019714HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19715in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19716track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19717syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19718about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019719
19720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197218.2. Log formats
19722----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019723
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019724HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019725and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19726slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19727options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019728
19729 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19730 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19731 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19732 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19733 extents.
19734
19735 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19736 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19737 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19738 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19739 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19740
19741 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19742 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19743 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19744 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19745 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19746
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019747 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19748 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19749 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19750 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19751
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019752 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19753
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19755specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19756field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19757servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19758always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19759identifier.
19760
19761Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19762 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19763 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19764 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19765 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19766
19767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197688.2.1. Default log format
19769-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019770
19771This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19772as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19773format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19774
19775 Example :
19776 listen www
19777 mode http
19778 log global
19779 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19780
19781 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19782 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19783 (www/HTTP)
19784
19785 Field Format Extract from the example above
19786 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19787 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19788 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19789 4 'to' to
19790 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19791 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19792
19793Detailed fields description :
19794 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19795 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19796 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19797 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19798 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19799 and processed the connection.
19800 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19801
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019802In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19803"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19804connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19807will eventually disappear.
19808
19809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198108.2.2. TCP log format
19811---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019812
19813The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19814is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19815information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19816counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19817emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19818environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19819the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19820sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019821specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19822not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19823fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19824marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019825
19826 Example :
19827 frontend fnt
19828 mode tcp
19829 option tcplog
19830 log global
19831 default_backend bck
19832
19833 backend bck
19834 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19835
19836 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19837 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19838 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19839
19840 Field Format Extract from the example above
19841 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19842 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19843 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19844 4 frontend_name fnt
19845 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19846 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19847 7 bytes_read* 212
19848 8 termination_state --
19849 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19850 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19851
19852Detailed fields description :
19853 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019854 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19855 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19856 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019857 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019858 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019859 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019860
19861 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019862 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19863 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19864 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019865
19866 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19867 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19868 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019869 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19870 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19871 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19872 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019873
19874 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19875 and processed the connection.
19876
19877 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19878 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19879 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19880 applications.
19881
19882 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19883 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19884 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19885 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19886 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19887
19888 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19889 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19890 See "Timers" below for more details.
19891
19892 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19893 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19894 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19895 "Timers" below for more details.
19896
19897 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019898 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019899 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19900 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19901 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19902 details.
19903
19904 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19905 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19906 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19907 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19908 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19909
19910 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19911 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19912 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19913 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19914 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19915 for more details.
19916
19917 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019918 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019919 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19920 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19921 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019922 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019923
19924 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19925 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19926 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19927 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19928 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19929 caused by a denial of service attack.
19930
19931 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19932 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19933 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19934 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19935 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19936 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19937 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19938 denial of service attack.
19939
19940 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19941 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19942 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19943 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19944 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19945 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19946 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19947 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19948 be processed than on other servers.
19949
19950 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19951 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19952 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19953 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19954 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19955 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19956 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19957 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19958 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19959 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19960 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19961 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19962 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19963
19964 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19965 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19966 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19967 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19968 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19969 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019970 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19972
19973 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19974 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19975 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19976 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19977 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19978 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019979 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019980 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19981 occurs.
19982
19983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199848.2.3. HTTP log format
19985----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019986
19987The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19988is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19989the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19990are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19991emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19992generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19993"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19994which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019995frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19996is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019997
19998Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19999slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20000with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20001
20002 Example :
20003 frontend http-in
20004 mode http
20005 option httplog
20006 log global
20007 default_backend bck
20008
20009 backend static
20010 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20011
20012 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20013 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20014 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020015 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016
20017 Field Format Extract from the example above
20018 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20019 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020020 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020021 4 frontend_name http-in
20022 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020023 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020024 7 status_code 200
20025 8 bytes_read* 2750
20026 9 captured_request_cookie -
20027 10 captured_response_cookie -
20028 11 termination_state ----
20029 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20030 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20031 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20032 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20033 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020035Detailed fields description :
20036 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020037 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20038 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20039 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020040 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020041 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020042 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020043
20044 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020045 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20046 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20047 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020049 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20050 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020051
20052 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20053 and processed the connection.
20054
20055 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20056 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20057 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20058
20059 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20060 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20061 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20062 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20063 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20064 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20065
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020066 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20067 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20068 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020069 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020070 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20071 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020072 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20073 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020074
20075 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20076 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020077 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078
20079 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20080 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020081 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20082 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020083
20084 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20085 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20086 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20087 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20088 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020089 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20090 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020091
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020092 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20093 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20094 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20095 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20096 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20097 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20098 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020099 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100
20101 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20102 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20103 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20104
20105 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20106 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020107 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020108 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20109 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20110 overflowing.
20111
20112 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20113 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20114 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20115 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20116 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20117 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20118 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20119 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20120
20121 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20122 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20123 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20124 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20125 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20126 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20127 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20128 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20129
20130 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20131 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20132 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20133 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20134 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20135 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20136 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20137
20138 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020139 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020140 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20141 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20142 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020143 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020144 system.
20145
20146 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20147 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20148 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20149 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20150 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20151 caused by a denial of service attack.
20152
20153 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20154 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20155 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20156 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20157 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20158 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20159 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20160 denial of service attack.
20161
20162 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20163 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20164 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20165 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20166 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20167 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20168 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20169 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20170 processed than on other servers.
20171
20172 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20173 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20174 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20175 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20176 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20177 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20178 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20179 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20180 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20181 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20182 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20183 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20184 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20185
20186 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20187 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20188 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20189 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20190 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20191 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020192 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20194
20195 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20196 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20197 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20198 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20199 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20200 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020201 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20203 occurs.
20204
20205 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20206 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20207 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20208 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20209 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20210 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20211 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20212 cookies" below for more details.
20213
20214 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20215 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20216 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20217 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20218 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20219 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20220 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20221 and cookies" below for more details.
20222
20223 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20224 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20225 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20226 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20227 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20228 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20229 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20230 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20231
20232
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200202338.2.4. Custom log format
20234------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020235
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020236The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020237mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020238
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020239HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020240Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20241separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20242prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20243
20244Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20245variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020246("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020247
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020248If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020249as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020250less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20251the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20252
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020253Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20254"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20255delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20256preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020257
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020258Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20259'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20260https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20261such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20262
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020263Flags are :
20264 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020265 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020266 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20267 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020268
20269 Example:
20270
20271 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20272 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20273
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020274 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20275
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020276At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20277
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020278 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20279 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020280
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020281the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020282
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020283 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20284 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20285 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020286
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020287and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20288
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020289 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20290 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020291
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020292Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20293
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020294 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020295 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020296 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20297 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20298 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020299 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20300 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20301 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020302 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020303 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020304 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020305 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020306 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020307 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20308 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020309 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020310 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020311 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020312 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020313 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020314 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020315 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020316 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20317 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20318 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20319 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20320 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020321 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020322 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020323 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020324 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020325 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020326 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20327 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020328 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20329 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20330 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020331 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020332 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20333 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020334 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020335 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20336 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20337 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020338 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020339 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020340 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20341 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20342 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20343 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020344 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020345 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020346 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020347 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020348 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020349 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020350 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20351 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20352 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020353 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020354 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20355 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020356 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020357 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20358 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020359 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020360 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020361 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020362 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020363
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020364 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020365
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020366
203678.2.5. Error log format
20368-----------------------
20369
20370When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20371protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20372By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20373"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020374will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020375logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20376
20377The format looks like this :
20378
20379 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20380 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20381 Connection error during SSL handshake
20382
20383 Field Format Extract from the example above
20384 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20385 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20386 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20387 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20388 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20389
20390These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20391failures.
20392
20393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203948.3. Advanced logging options
20395-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020396
20397Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20398just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20399options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20400for more information about their usage.
20401
20402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20404------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020405
20406It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20407haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20408commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20409monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20410ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20411
20412 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20413 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20414 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20415 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20416
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020417 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20418 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020419
20420 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20421 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20422 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20423
20424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20426----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427
20428The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20429what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20430or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020431"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020432just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20433log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20434after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20435is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20436with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20437with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20438
20439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20441------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020442
20443Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20444for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20445"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20446retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20447raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20448a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20449file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20450you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20451"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20452
20453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20455--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020456
20457Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20458multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20459them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20460"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20461logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20462error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20463and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20464too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20465useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20466alternative.
20467
20468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204698.4. Timing events
20470------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020471
20472Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20473reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20474the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20475frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020476mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20477addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20478
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020479Timings events in HTTP mode:
20480
20481 first request 2nd request
20482 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20483 t tr t tr ...
20484 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20485 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20486 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20487 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020488 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020489 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20490
20491Timings events in TCP mode:
20492
20493 TCP session
20494 |<----------------->|
20495 t t
20496 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20497 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20498 |<------ Tt ------->|
20499
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020500 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020501 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020502 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20503 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20504 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020505 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020506 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20507 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20508 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20509 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020510
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020511 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20512 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20513 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020514 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20515 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20516 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20517 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20518 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20519 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020520
20521 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20522 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20523 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20524 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20525 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20526 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20527 request typed by hand during a test.
20528
20529 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20530 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020531 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20533 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20534 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20535 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020536
20537 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20538 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20539 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20540 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20541 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20542
20543 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20544 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20545 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20546 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20547 connection never established.
20548
20549 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20550 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20551 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20552 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20553 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20554 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20555 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20556 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20557 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20558 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20559 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020561 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20562 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20563 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20564 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20565 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20566 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20567
20568 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20569
20570 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20571 "Ta" can never be negative.
20572
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020573 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20574 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020575 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20576 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020577 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020578
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020579 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580
20581 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020582 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20583 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020585 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20586 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20587 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20588 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20589 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20590 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20591 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20592 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20593
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020594These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20595protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20596that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020597due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20598"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20599that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020600
20601Most common cases :
20602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020603 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20604 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20605 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20606 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20607 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20608 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20609 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20610 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20611 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20612 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20613 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020614 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020615
20616 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20617 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20618 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20619 of ms on remote networks.
20620
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020621 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20622 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20623 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020625 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20626 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20627 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20628 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20629 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20630 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20631 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20632 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20633 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020634
20635Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020637 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020638 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020639 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020640
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020641 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020642 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20643 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20644
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020645 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020646 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20647 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20648 flags.
20649
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020650 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20651 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020652 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20653 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20654 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20655 the client connection was maintained open.
20656
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020657 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020658 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020659 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020660 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20661
20662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206638.5. Session state at disconnection
20664-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020665
20666TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20667"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
206682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20669each of which has a special meaning :
20670
20671 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20672 session to terminate :
20673
20674 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20675
20676 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20677 server explicitly refused it.
20678
20679 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20680 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20681 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20682 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020683 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020684
20685 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20686 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020687
20688 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20689 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20690 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20691 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20692 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20693
20694 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20695 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20696 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20697 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20698 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20699
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020700 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20701 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20702
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020703 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20704 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20705 backup connections when going up.
20706
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020707 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020709 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20710 send or receive data.
20711
20712 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20713 send or receive data.
20714
20715 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20716 with nothing left in the buffers.
20717
20718 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20719
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020720 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020721 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20722
20723 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20724 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20725 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20726 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20727 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20728
20729 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20730 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20731
20732 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20733 server (HTTP only).
20734
20735 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20736
20737 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20738 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20739 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20740
20741 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20742 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20743 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20744
20745 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20746
20747 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20748 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20749
20750 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20751 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20752 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20753
20754 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20755 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020756 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20757 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020758
20759 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20760 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20761 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20762 another server.
20763
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020764 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020765 server.
20766
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020767 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20768 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20769 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20770 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20771
20772 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20773 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20774 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20775 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20776
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020777 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20778 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20779 "use-server" rule).
20780
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020781 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20782
20783 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20784 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20785
20786 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20787
20788 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20789 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20790 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20791
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020792 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20793 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020794 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020795 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20796 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020798 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20799
20800 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20801 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20802
20803 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20804
20805 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20806
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020807The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20808was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020809helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20810starvation, attacks, etc...
20811
20812The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20813alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20814easier finding and understanding.
20815
20816 Flags Reason
20817
20818 -- Normal termination.
20819
20820 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20821 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20822 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20823 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20824
20825 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20826 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20827 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20828 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20829 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20830 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020831
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020832 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20833 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020834 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020835
20836 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20837 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20838 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20839
20840 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20841 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20842 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20843 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20844 the server takes too long to respond.
20845
20846 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20847 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20848 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20849 long a time to respond.
20850
20851 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20852 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20853 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20854 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020855 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20856 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020857
20858 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20859 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20860 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20861 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20862 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020863 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020864 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20865 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20866 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20867 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20868 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20869 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20870 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20871 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020872 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020873 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20874 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20875 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020876
20877 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20878 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020879 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20880 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20881 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20882 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020883
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020884 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20885 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020887 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20889 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020890 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020891 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20892 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20893
20894 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20895 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20896 503 or 504 here.
20897
20898 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20899 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20900 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20901 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20902 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20903
20904 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20905 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020906 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020907 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20908 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20909
20910 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20911 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20912 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20913 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20914 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20915 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20916 between haproxy and the server.
20917
20918 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20919 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20920 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20921 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20922 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20923 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20924 solution is to fix the application.
20925
20926 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20927 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20928 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20929 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20930 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20931 external attacks.
20932
20933 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020934 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020935 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20937 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20938
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020939 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20940 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20941 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020942 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020943 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020944
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020945 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20946 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20947 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20948 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020949 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20950 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20951 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20952 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20953 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020954
20955 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20956 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20957 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20958 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20959
20960 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20961 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20962 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20963 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20964
20965 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20966 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20967 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20968 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020970The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20971persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20972important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20973re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20974
20975 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20976
20977 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20978 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20979 set on a GET request.
20980
20981 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20982 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020983 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020984 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20985
20986 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20987 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20988 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20989
20990 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20991 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20992 already got a cookie.
20993
20994 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20995 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20996 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20997 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20998 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20999
21000 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21001 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21002 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21003
21004 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21005 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21006 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21007
21008 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21009 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21010
21011 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21012 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21013 then advertised in the response.
21014
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210168.6. Non-printable characters
21017-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021018
21019In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21020consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21021converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21022prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21023being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21024escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21025is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21026'}' when logging headers.
21027
21028Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21029issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21030containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21031
21032Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21033the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21034performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21035
21036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21038---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021039
21040Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21041achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021042section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021043cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21044the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21045the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021046locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021047not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21048user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21049a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21050wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21051
21052 Examples :
21053 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21054 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21055
21056 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21057 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21058
21059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21061---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021062
21063Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21064proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21065the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21066server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21067
21068Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21069response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021070section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071
21072It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021073time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21074appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021075are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21076and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21077follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21078request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21079in the logs.
21080
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021081As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21082frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21083an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21084
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021085 Example :
21086 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21087 listen proxy-out
21088 mode http
21089 option httplog
21090 option logasap
21091 log global
21092 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21093
21094 # log the name of the virtual server
21095 capture request header Host len 20
21096
21097 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21098 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21099
21100 # log the beginning of the referrer
21101 capture request header Referer len 20
21102
21103 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21104 capture response header Server len 20
21105
21106 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21107 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21108
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021109 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021110 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21111
21112 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21113 capture response header Via len 20
21114
21115 # log the URL location during a redirection
21116 capture response header Location len 20
21117
21118 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21119 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21120 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21121 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21122 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21123
21124 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21125 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21126 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21127 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021128 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021129
21130 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21131 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21132 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21133 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21134 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021135 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136
21137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211388.9. Examples of logs
21139---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021140
21141These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21142them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21143reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21144
21145 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21146 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21147 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21148
21149 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21150 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21151
21152 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21153 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21154 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21155
21156 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21157 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21158
21159 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21160 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21161 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21162
21163 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021164 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21166 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21167
21168 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21169 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21170 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21171
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021172 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21173 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21174 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21175 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21176 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21177 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021178
21179 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021180 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021181
21182 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21183 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21184 Nothing was sent to any server.
21185
21186 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21187 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21188
21189 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21190 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021191 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021192 send a 408 return code to the client.
21193
21194 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21195 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21196
21197 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21198 5 seconds ("c----").
21199
21200 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21201 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021202 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021203
21204 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021205 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021206 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21207 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21208 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21209 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21210 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021211
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021212
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200212139. Supported filters
21214--------------------
21215
21216Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21217accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21218unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21219
21220See also : "filter"
21221
212229.1. Trace
21223----------
21224
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021225filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021226
21227 Arguments:
21228 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21229 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21230
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021231 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021232
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021233 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021234 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21235 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21236 amount of the parsed data.
21237
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021238 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021239
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021240This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21241callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21242information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21243filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21244
21245Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21246tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21247a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21248
21249
212509.2. HTTP compression
21251---------------------
21252
21253filter compression
21254
21255The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21256keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021257when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21258fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21259done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21260explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21261filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21262listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21263order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021264
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021265See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21266 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021267
21268
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200212699.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21270--------------------------------------------
21271
21272filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21273
21274 Arguments :
21275
21276 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21277 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21278 parsed.
21279
21280 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21281 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21282 part must be placed in its own scope.
21283
21284The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21285external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021286streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021287exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21288also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21289
21290SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21291the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21292
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021293For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021294"doc/SPOE.txt".
21295
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100212969.4. Cache
21297----------
21298
21299filter cache <name>
21300
21301 Arguments :
21302
21303 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21304
21305The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21306"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021307cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021308other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21309case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21310is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21311filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021312listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21313order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021314
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021315See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21316 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21317
21318
213199.5. Fcgi-app
21320-------------
21321
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021322filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021323
21324 Arguments :
21325
21326 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21327
21328The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21329request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21330reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21331used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21332implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21333used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21334fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21335used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21336order.
21337
21338See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21339 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21340
21341
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100213429.6. OpenTracing
21343----------------
21344
21345The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21346HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21347of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21348Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21349
21350This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21351
21352The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21353HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21354participates in the work of HAProxy.
21355
21356filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21357
21358 Arguments :
21359
21360 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21361 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21362 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21363 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21364 OpenTracing filters.
21365
21366 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21367 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21368 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21369 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21370 filter must have its own scope defined.
21371
21372More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021373of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021374
21375
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002137610. FastCGI applications
21377-------------------------
21378
21379HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21380feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21381the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21382FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21383servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21384FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21385backend.
21386
21387HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21388application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21389connection.
21390
2139110.1. Setup
21392-----------
21393
2139410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21395--------------------------
21396
21397fcgi-app <name>
21398 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21399 document root must be defined.
21400
21401acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21402 Declare or complete an access list.
21403
21404 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21405 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21406 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21407 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21408 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21409
21410docroot <path>
21411 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21412 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21413 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21414
21415index <script-name>
21416 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21417 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21418 is an optional setting.
21419
21420 Example :
21421 index index.php
21422
21423log-stderr global
21424log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021425 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021426 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21427
21428 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21429 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21430
21431pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21432 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21433 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21434 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21435
21436 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21437 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21438 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21439 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21440
21441 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21442 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21443
21444path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021445 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021446 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21447 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21448 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21449 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21450 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21451 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21452 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021453
21454 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021455 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021456 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21457 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21458 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21459 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021460
21461 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021462 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21463 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021464
21465option get-values
21466no option get-values
21467 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21468
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021469 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021470 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21471
21472 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21473 application will accept.
21474
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021475 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21476 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021477
21478 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021479 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021480 option is disabled.
21481
21482 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21483 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21484 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21485 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21486 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21487 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21488
21489option keep-conn
21490no option keep-conn
21491 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21492 sending a response.
21493
21494 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21495 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21496
21497option max-reqs <reqs>
21498 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21499 accept.
21500
21501 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21502 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21503 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21504 to 1.
21505
21506option mpxs-conns
21507no option mpxs-conns
21508 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21509
21510 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21511 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21512
21513set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21514 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21515 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21516 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21517 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21518
21519 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21520 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21521 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21522
21523 Example :
21524 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21525 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21526
21527 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21528
21529
2153010.1.2. Proxy section
21531---------------------
21532
21533use-fcgi-app <name>
21534 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21535
21536 Arguments :
21537 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21538
21539 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21540 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21541 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21542 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21543 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21544
21545 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21546 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21547 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21548 application are evaluated.
21549
21550
2155110.1.3. Example
21552---------------
21553
21554 frontend front-http
21555 mode http
21556 bind *:80
21557 bind *:
21558
21559 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21560 default_backend back-static
21561
21562 backend back-static
21563 mode http
21564 server www A.B.C.D:80
21565
21566 backend back-dynamic
21567 mode http
21568 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21569 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21570
21571 fcgi-app php-fpm
21572 log-stderr global
21573 option keep-conn
21574
21575 docroot /var/www/my-app
21576 index index.php
21577 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21578
21579
2158010.2. Default parameters
21581------------------------
21582
21583A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21584the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021585script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021586applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21587
21588 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21589 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21590 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21591 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21592 | | |
21593 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21594 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21595 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21596 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21597 | | application. |
21598 | | |
21599 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21600 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21601 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21602 | | |
21603 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21604 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21605 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21606 | | the application's configuration. |
21607 | | |
21608 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21609 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21610 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21611 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21612 | | |
21613 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21614 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21615 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21616 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21617 | | be defined. |
21618 | | |
21619 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21620 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21621 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21622 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21623 | | is not set too. |
21624 | | |
21625 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21626 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21627 | | set. |
21628 | | |
21629 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21630 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21631 | | the request. |
21632 | | |
21633 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21634 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21635 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21636 | | |
21637 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21638 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21639 | | script to process the request. |
21640 | | |
21641 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21642 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21643 | | |
21644 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21645 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21646 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21647 | | |
21648 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21649 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21650 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21651 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21652 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21653 | | |
21654 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21655 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21656 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21657 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21658 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21659 | | side. |
21660 | | |
21661 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21662 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21663 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21664 | | connected to. |
21665 | | |
21666 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21667 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21668 | | |
21669 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21670 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21671 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21672 | | |
21673 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21674
21675
2167610.3. Limitations
21677------------------
21678
21679The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21680way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21681during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21682establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21683application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21684or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21685message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21686these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21687and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21688
21689Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21690request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21691requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21692
21693About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21694into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21695fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21696"http-request" ones.
21697
21698Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21699FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21700processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21701must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21702here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021703
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021704
2170511. Address formats
21706-------------------
21707
21708Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21709address.
21710
21711This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21712The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21713of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21714equivalent is '::'.
21715
21716Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21717is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21718
21719This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21720family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21721
21722Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21723configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21724use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21725'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21726
21727Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21728socket type and the transport method.
21729
21730
2173111.1 Address family prefixes
21732----------------------------
21733
21734'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21735
21736'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21737 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21738 listening.
21739
21740'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21741 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21742 on the statement using this address, a port or
21743 a port range may or must be specified.
21744
21745'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21746 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21747 using this address, a port or a port range
21748 may or must be specified.
21749
21750'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21751 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21752 using this address, a port or a port range
21753 may or must be specified.
21754
21755'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21756 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21757 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21758 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21759 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21760 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21761
21762'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21763 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21764 start by slash '/'.
21765
21766
2176711.2 Socket type prefixes
21768-------------------------
21769
21770Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21771type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21772this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21773This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21774but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21775
21776Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21777instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21778
21779If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21780they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21781report this to the maintainers.
21782
21783'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21784 to "stream"
21785
21786'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21787 to "datagram".
21788
21789
2179011.3 Protocol prefixes
21791----------------------
21792
21793'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21794 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21795 socket type and transport method is forced to
21796 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21797 this address, a port or a port range can or
21798 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21799 of 'stream+ip@'.
21800
21801'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21802 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21803 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21804 statement using this address, a port or port
21805 range can or must be specified.
21806 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21807
21808'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21809 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21810 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21811 statement using this address, a port or port
21812 range can or must be specified.
21813 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21814
21815'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21816 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21817 socket type and transport method is forced to
21818 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21819 this address, a port or a port range can or
21820 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21821 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21822
21823'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21824 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21825 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21826 the statement using this address, a port or
21827 port range can or must be specified.
21828 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21829
21830'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21831 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21832 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21833 the statement using this address, a port or
21834 port range can or must be specified.
21835 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21836
21837'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21838 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21839 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21840
21841'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21842 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21843 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21844
21845In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21846QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021848/*
21849 * Local variables:
21850 * fill-column: 79
21851 * End:
21852 */